PIC16F753/HV753 14/16-Pin, Flash-Based 8-Bit CMOS Microcontrollers High-Performance RISC CPU: Peripheral Features: • Only 35 Instructions to Learn: - All single-cycle instructions except branches • Operating Speed: - DC – 20 MHz clock input - DC – 200 ns instruction cycle • 2048 x 14 On-chip Flash Program Memory • Self Read/Write Program Memory • 128 x 8 General Purpose Registers (SRAM) • Interrupt Capability • 8-Level Deep Hardware Stack • Direct, Indirect and Relative Addressing modes • 11 I/O Pins and one Input-only Pin • High Current Source/Sink: - 50 mA I/O, (two pins) - 25 mA I/O, (nine pins) • Two High-Speed Analog Comparator modules: - 50 ns response time - Fixed Voltage Reference (FVR) - Programmable on-chip voltage reference via integrated 9-bit DAC - Internal/external inputs and outputs (selectable) - Built-in Hysteresis (software selectable) • A/D Converter: - 10-bit resolution - Eight external channels - Two internal reference voltage channels • Operational Amplifier: - Three terminal operations - Internal connections to DAC and FVR • Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC): - 9-bit resolution - Full Range output - 4 mV steps @ 2.0V (Limited Range) • Fixed Voltage Reference (FVR), 1.2V Reference • Capture, Compare, PWM (CCP) module: - 16-bit Capture, max. resolution = 12.5 ns - 16-bit Compare, max. resolution = 200 ns - 10-bit PWM, max. frequency = 20 kHz • Timer0: 8-Bit Timer/Counter with 8-Bit Prescaler • Enhanced Timer1: - 16-bit Timer/Counter with Prescaler - External Timer1 Gate (count enable) - Four Selectable Clock sources • Timer2: 8-Bit Timer/Counter with Prescaler - 8-Bit Period Register and Postscaler • Two Hardware Limit Timers (HLT): - 8-bit Timer with Prescaler - 8-bit period register and postscaler - Asynchronous H/W Reset sources • Complementary Output Generator (COG): - Complementary Waveforms from selectable sources - Two I/O (50 mA) for direct MOSFET drive - Rising and/or Falling edge dead-band control - Phase control, Blanking control - Auto-shutdown - Slope Compensation Circuit for use with SMPS power supplies Microcontroller Features: • Precision Internal Oscillator: - Factory calibrated to ±1%, typical - Software selectable frequency: 8 MHz, 4 MHz, 1 MHz or 31 kHz - Software tunable • Power-Saving Sleep mode • Voltage Range (PIC16F753): - 2.0V to 5.5V • Shunt Voltage Regulator (PIC16HV753): - 2.0V to user defined - 5-volt regulation - 1 mA to 50 mA shunt range • Multiplexed Master Clear with Pull-up/Input Pin • Interrupt-on-Change Pins • Individually Programmable Weak Pull-ups • Power-on Reset (POR) • Power-up Timer (PWRT) • Brown-out Reset (BOR) • Watchdog Timer (WDT) with Internal Oscillator for Reliable Operation • Industrial and Extended Temperature Range • High Endurance Flash: - 100,000 write Flash endurance - Flash retention: >40 years • Programmable Code Protection • In-Circuit Debug (ICD) via Two Pins • In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) via Two Pins Low-Power Features: • Standby Current: - 50 nA @ 2.0V, typical • Operating Current: - 11 uA @ 32 kHz, 2.0V, typical - 260 uA @ 4 MHz, 2.0V, typical • Watchdog Timer Current: • <1 uA @ 2.0V, typical 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 1 PIC16F753/HV753 Program Memory Flash (words) Self Read/Write Flash Memory Data SRAM (bytes) I/Os(2) 10-bit ADC (ch) Comparators Timers (8/16-bit) CCP Complementary Output Generator (COG) DAC Op Amp Shunt Regulator Debug(1) PIC16F753/HV753 FAMILY TYPES Data Sheet Index TABLE 1: PIC12F752 (1) 1K Y 64 6 4 2 3/1 1 Y 5-bit N N H PIC12HV752 (1) 1K Y 64 6 4 2 3/1 1 Y 5-bit N Y H PIC16F753 (2) 2K Y 128 12 8 2 3/1 1 Y 9-bit Y N I/H PIC16HV753 (2) 2K Y 128 12 8 2 3/1 1 Y 9-bit Y Y I/H Device Note 1: I - Debugging, Integrated on Chip; H - Debugging, Requires Debug Header. 2: One pin is input-only. Data Sheet Index: (Unshaded devices are described in this document.) 1: DS41576 PIC12F752/HV752 Data Sheet, 8-Pin Flash-Based, 8-Bit CMOS Microcontrollers. 2: DS40001709 PIC16F753/HV753 Data Sheet, 14/16-Pin Flash-based, 8-Bit CMOS Microcontrollers. Note: For other small form-factor package availability and marking information, please visit http://www.microchip.com/packaging or contact your local sales office. Pin Diagram – 14-Pin PDIP, SOIC, TSSOP 1 14 RA5 RA4 2 13 VSS RA0/ICSPDAT 12 RA1/ICSPCLK 11 RA2 10 RC0 9 RC1 8 RC2 MCLR/VPP/RA3 3 4 RC5 5 RC4 6 RC3 7 PIC16F753/HV753 VDD Note: See Table 2 for location of all peripheral functions. DS40001709A-page 2 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 Pin Diagram – 16-Pin QFN VDD NC NC Vss (4x4) 16 15 14 13 RA5 RA4 MCLR/VPP/RA3 RC5 1 12 2 PIC16F753/HV75311 3 10 4 9 RA0/ICSPDAT RA1/ICSPCLK RA2 RC0 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 5 6 7 8 Note: See Table 2 for location of all peripheral functions. 14-Pin PDIP/SOIC/TSSOP 16-Pin QFN ADC Reference Op Amp Comparator Timer CCP Interrupt Pull-up Slope Compensation Basic 14/16-PIN ALLOCATION TABLE FOR PIC16F753/HV753 I/O TABLE 2: RA0 13 12 AN0 FVROUT DACOUT — C1IN0+ — — IOC Y — ICSPDAT RA1 12 11 AN1 VREF FVRIN — C1IN0C2IN0- — — IOC Y — ICSPCLK RA2 11 10 AN2 COG1FLT — C1OUT T0CKI — INT IOC Y — — RA3 4 3 — — — — T1G(2) — IOC Y — MCLR/ VPP RA4 3 2 AN3 — — — T1G(1) — IOC Y — CLKOUT RA5 2 1 — — — — T1CKI — IOC Y — CLKIN RC0 10 9 AN4 — OPAxIN+ C2IN0+ — — IOC — — — RC1 9 8 AN5 — OPAxIN- C1IN1C2IN1- — — IOC — — — RC2 8 7 AN6 — OPAxOUT C1IN2C2IN2- — — IOC — SLPCIN — RC3 7 6 AN7 — — C1IN3C2IN3- — — IOC — — — RC4 6 5 — COG1OUT1 — C2OUT — — IOC — — — RC5 5 4 — COG1OUT0 — — — CCP1 IOC — — — VDD 1 16 — — — — — — — — — VDD VSS 14 13 — — — — — — — — — VSS Note 1: 2: Default location for peripheral pin function. Alternate location can be selected using the APFCON register. Alternate location for peripheral pin function selected by the APFCON register. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 3 PIC16F753/HV753 Table of Contents 1.0 Device Overview ......................................................................................................................................................................... 7 2.0 Memory Organization ................................................................................................................................................................ 11 3.0 Flash Program Memory Self Read/Self Write Control ............................................................................................................... 27 4.0 Oscillator Module ....................................................................................................................................................................... 37 5.0 I/O Ports .................................................................................................................................................................................... 43 6.0 Timer0 Module .......................................................................................................................................................................... 59 7.0 Timer1 Module with Gate Control .............................................................................................................................................. 63 8.0 Timer2 Module .......................................................................................................................................................................... 75 9.0 Hardware Limit Timer (HLT) Module ......................................................................................................................................... 77 10.0 Capture/Compare/PWM Modules ............................................................................................................................................. 81 11.0 Complementary Output Generator (COG) Module .................................................................................................................... 89 12.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module ............................................................................................................................. 113 13.0 Fixed Voltage Reference (FVR) .............................................................................................................................................. 125 14.0 Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Module ............................................................................................................................. 127 15.0 Comparator Module ................................................................................................................................................................. 133 16.0 Operational Amplifier (OPA) Module ....................................................................................................................................... 143 17.0 Slope Compensator.................................................................................................................................................................. 145 18.0 Instruction Set Summary ......................................................................................................................................................... 151 19.0 Special Features of the CPU ................................................................................................................................................... 161 20.0 Shunt Regulator (PIC12HV752 Only) ...................................................................................................................................... 181 21.0 Development Support .............................................................................................................................................................. 183 22.0 Electrical Specifications ........................................................................................................................................................... 187 23.0 DC and AC Characteristics Graphs and Charts ...................................................................................................................... 213 24.0 Packaging Information ............................................................................................................................................................. 215 Index ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 229 The Microchip Web Site .................................................................................................................................................................... 233 Customer Change Notification Service ............................................................................................................................................. 233 Customer Support ............................................................................................................................................................................. 233 Reader Response ............................................................................................................................................................................. 234 Product Identification System ............................................................................................................................................................ 235 DS40001709A-page 4 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced. If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via E-mail at [email protected] or fax the Reader Response Form in the back of this data sheet to (480) 792-4150. We welcome your feedback. Most Current Data Sheet To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Web site at: http://www.microchip.com You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page. The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000A is version A of document DS30000). Errata An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision of silicon and revision of document to which it applies. To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following: • Microchip’s Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com • Your local Microchip sales office (see last page) When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are using. Customer Notification System Register on our web site at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 5 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 6 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 1.0 DEVICE OVERVIEW Block Diagrams and pinout descriptions of the devices are shown in Figure 1-1 and Table 1-1. The PIC16F753/HV753 devices are covered by this data sheet. They are available in 14-pin PDIP, SOIC, TSSOP and 16-pin QFN packages. FIGURE 1-1: PIC16F753/HV753 BLOCK DIAGRAM INT Configuration 13 Flash 2K X 14 Program Memory Program Bus PORTA RA0 RA1 RA2 RAM 64 Bytes File Registers 8-Level Stack (13-Bit) 14 RAM Addr RA3 RA4 RA5 9 PORTC Addr MUX Instruction Reg Direct Addr 7 Power-up Timer Timing Generation Watchdog Timer RC3 RC4 STATUS Reg RC5 MUX ALU Power-on Reset 8 W Reg Capture/ Compare/ PWM (CCP) Shunt Regulator (PIC16HV753 only) Hardware Limit Timer1 (HLT) Brown-out Reset CLKOUT Internal Oscillator Block MCLR T1G VDD RC1 RC2 FSR Reg 3 Instruction Decode & Control RC0 Indirect Addr 8 8 CLKIN 8 Data Bus Program Counter VSS T1CKI Timer0 T0CKI Slope Compensator Fixed Voltage Reference (FVR) Timer1 Dual Range DAC Timer2 Analog Comparator and Reference Preliminary C1IN0+/C2IN0+ C1IN0-/C2IN0C1IN1C2IN1C1OUT/C2OUT Op. Amp. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Complementary Output Generator (COG) DS40001709A-page 7 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 1-1: PIC16F753/HV753 PINOUT DESCRIPTION Name RA0/C1IN0+/C2IN0+/AN0/ DACOUT/REFOUT/ ICSPDAT RA1/C1IN0-/C2IN0-/AN1/ VREF+/FVRIN/ICSPCLK RA2/INT/CCP1/C2OUT/ C1OUT/T0CKI/ COG1OUT0(2)/AN2/ COG1FLT RA3(1)/T1G(3)/VPP/MCLR(4) (2) (3) RA4/T1G /COG1OUT1 / COG1FLT(2)/C1IN1-/AN3/ CLKOUT RA5/T1CKI/COG1OUT0(3)/ C2IN1-/CLKIN Function Input Type Output Type Description RA0 TTL HP General purpose I/O with IOC and WPU. C1IN0+ AN — Comparator C1 positive input. C2IN0+ AN — Comparator C2 positive input. AN0 AN — A/D Channel 0 input. DACOUT — AN DAC unbuffered Voltage Reference output. REFOUT — AN DAC/FVR buffered Voltage Reference output. ICSPDAT ST HP RA1 TTL CMOS Serial Programming Data I/O. C1IN0- AN — Comparator C1 negative input. C2IN0- AN — Comparator C2 negative input. General purpose I/O with IOC and WPU. AN1 AN — A/D Channel 1 input. VREF+ AN — A/D Positive Voltage Reference input. FVRIN AN — Voltage reference input. ICSPCLK ST — Serial Programming Clock. RA2 ST HP General purpose I/O with IOC and WPU. INT ST — External interrupt. CCP1 ST HP Capture/Compare/PWM 1. C2OUT — HP Comparator C2 output. C1OUT — HP Comparator C1 output. T0CKI ST — Timer0 clock input. COG1OUT0 — HP COG output channel 0. AN2 AN — A/D Channel 2 input. COG1FLT ST — COG auto-shutdown fault input. RA3 TTL — General purpose input with WPU. T1G ST — Timer1 Gate input. VPP HV — Programming voltage. MCLR ST — Master Clear w/internal pull-up. RA4 TTL CMOS T1G ST — COG1OUT1 — CMOS COG1FLT ST — COG auto-shutdown fault input. C1IN1- AN — Comparator C1 negative input. AN3 AN — A/D Channel 3 input. General purpose I/O with IOC and WPU. Timer1 Gate input. COG output channel 1 CLKOUT — CMOS FOSC/4 output. RA5 TTL CMOS General purpose I/O with IOC and WPU. T1CKI ST — COG1OUT0 — CMOS Timer1 clock input. C2IN1- AN — Comparator C2 negative input. CLKIN ST — External Clock input (EC mode). COG output channel 0. Legend: AN = Analog input or output CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output TTL = TTL compatible input ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels HP = High Power HV = High Voltage * Alternate pin function. Note 1: Input only. 2: Default pin function via the APFCON register. 3: Alternate pin function via the APFCON register. 4: RA3 pull-up is enabled when pin is configured as MCLR in Configuration Word. DS40001709A-page 8 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 1-1: PIC16F753/HV753 PINOUT DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED) Function Input Type Output Type VDD Power — VSS VSS Power — RC0/OPA1IN+/AN4/C2IN0+ RC0 TTL CMOS Name VDD RC1/OPA1IN-/AN5/C1IN1-/ C2IN1- RC2/SLPCIN/AN6/ OPA1OUT/C1IN2-/C2IN2- Description Positive supply. Ground reference. General purpose I/O. OPA1IN+ AN — Op amp positive input. AN4 AN — A/D Channel 4 input. C2IN0+ AN — RC1 TTL CMOS Comparator C2 positive input. OPA1IN- AN — Op amp negative input. AN5 AN — A/D Channel 5 input. C1IN1- AN — Comparator C1 negative input. C2IN1- AN — RC2 TTL CMOS SLPCIN AN — General purpose I/O. Comparator C2 negative input. General purpose I/O. Slope Compensator input. AN6 AN — A/D Channel 6 input. OPA1OUT AN HP Op amp output. C1IN2- AN — Comparator C1 negative input. C2IN2- AN — Comparator C2 negative input. RC3 TTL CMOS AN7 AN — A/D Channel 7 input. C1IN3- AN — Comparator C1 negative input. C2IN3- AN — Comparator C2 negative input. RC3/AN7/C1IN3-/C2IN3- RC4/COG1OUT1/C2OUT General purpose I/O. RC4 TTL CMOS COG1OUT1 — CMOS COG output Channel 1. C2OUT — HP Comparator C2 output. RC5 TTL CMOS COG1OUT0 — CMOS CCP1 — HP RC5/COG1OUT0/CCP1 General purpose I/O. General purpose I/O. COG output Channel 0. Capture/Compare/PWM 1. Legend: AN = Analog input or output CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output TTL = TTL compatible input ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels HP = High Power HV = High Voltage * Alternate pin function. Note 1: Input only. 2: Default pin function via the APFCON register. 3: Alternate pin function via the APFCON register. 4: RA3 pull-up is enabled when pin is configured as MCLR in Configuration Word. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 9 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 10 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 2.0 MEMORY ORGANIZATION 2.1 Program Memory Organization 2.2 The PIC16F753/HV753 has a 13-bit program counter capable of addressing an 8K x 14 program memory space. Only the first 2K x 14 (0000h-07FFh) is physically implemented. Accessing a location above these boundaries will cause a wrap-around within the first 2K x 14 space for PIC16F753/HV753. The Reset vector is at 0000h and the interrupt vector is at 0004h (see Figure 2-1). FIGURE 2-1: PROGRAM MEMORY MAP AND STACK FOR THE PIC16F753/HV753 PC<12:0> CALL, RETURN RETFIE, RETLW 13 Stack Level 1 Stack Level 8 Reset Vector The data memory (see Figure 2-2) is partitioned into four banks, which contain the General Purpose Registers (GPR) and the Special Function Registers (SFR). The Special Function Registers are located in the first 32 locations of each bank. Register locations 40h-6Fh in Bank 0 are General Purpose Registers, implemented as static RAM. Register locations 70h-7Fh in Bank 0 are Common RAM and shared as the last 16 addresses in all Banks. All other RAM is unimplemented and returns ‘0’ when read. The RP<1:0> bits of the STATUS register are the bank select bits. RP1 0000h 0 Bank 0 is selected 0 1 Bank 1 is selected 1 0 Bank 2 is selected 1 1 Bank 3 is selected 0004h 0005h On-chip Program Memory 07FFh 0400h Shadows 0-07FFh GENERAL PURPOSE REGISTER FILE The register file is organized as 64 x 8 in the PIC16F753/HV753. Each register is accessed, either directly or indirectly, through the File Select Register (FSR) (see Section 2.5 “Indirect Addressing, INDF and FSR Registers”). 2.2.2 Interrupt Vector RP0 0 2.2.1 Stack Level 2 Data Memory Organization SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS The Special Function Registers are registers used by the CPU and peripheral functions for controlling the desired operation of the device (see Table 2-1). These registers are static RAM. The special registers can be classified into two sets: core and peripheral. The Special Function Registers associated with the “core” are described in this section. Those related to the operation of the peripheral features are described in the section of that peripheral feature. 1FFFh 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 11 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 2-2: DATA MEMORY MAP OF THE PIC16F753/HV753 BANK 0 INDF TMR0 PCL STATUS FSR PORTA — PORTC IOCAF IOCCF PCLATH INTCON PIR1 PIR2 — TMR1L TMR1H T1CON T1GCON CCPR1L CCPR1H CCP1CON — — — — — — ADRESL ADRESH ADCON0 ADCON1 00h 01h 02h 03h 04h 05h 06h 07h 08h 09h 0Ah 0Bh 0Ch 0Dh 0Eh 0Fh 10h 11h 12h 13h 14h 15h 16h 17h 18h 19h 1Ah 1Bh 1Ch 1Dh 1Eh 1Fh 20h GPRs “gpr0” BANK 1 INDF OPTION_REG PCL STATUS FSR TRISA — TRISC IOCAP IOCCP PCLATH INTCON PIE1 PIE2 — OSCCON FVR1CON0 DAC1CON0 DAC1REFL DAC1REFH — — OPA1CON0 — — — — CM2CON0 CM2CON1 CM1CON0 CM1CON1 CMOUT 80h 81h 82h 83h 84h 85h 86h 87h 88h 89h 8Ah 8Bh 8Ch 8Dh 8Eh 8Fh 90h 91h 92h 93h 94h 95h 96h 97h 98h 99h 9Ah 9Bh 9Ch 9Dh 9Eh 9Fh A0h GPRs “gprnobank” BFh C0h Unimplemented 7Fh GPRs “gpr1s” (mirrors “gprnobank”) 100h 101h 102h 103h 104h 105h 106h 107h 108h 109h 10Ah 10Bh 10Ch 10Dh 10Eh 10Fh 110h 111h 112h 113h 114h 115h 116h 117h 118h 119h 11Ah 11Bh 11Ch 11Dh 11Eh 11Fh 120h Unimplemented GPRS “gpr1” 6Fh 70h BANK 2 INDF TMR0 PCL STATUS FSR LATA — LATC IOCAN IOCCN PCLATH INTCON WPUA WPUC SLRCONC PCON TMR2 PR2 T2CON HLTMR1 HLTPR1 HLT1CON0 HLT1CON1 HLTMR2 HLTPR2 HLT2CON0 HLT2CON1 — — — SLPCCON0 SLPCCON1 EFh F0h GPRs “gpr2s” (mirrors “gprnobank”) BANK 3 INDF OPTION_REG PCL STATUS FSR ANSELA — ANSELC APFCON OSCTUNE PCLATH INTCON PMCON1 PMCON2 PMADRL PMADRH PMDATL PMDATH COG1PHR COG1PHF COG1BKR COG1BKF COG1DBR COG1DBF COG1CON0 COG1CON1 COG1RIS COG1RSIM COG1FIS COG1FSIM COG1ASD0 COG1ASD1 180h 181h 182h 183h 184h 185h 186h 187h 188h 189h 18Ah 18Bh 18Ch 18Dh 18Eh 18Fh 190h 191h 192h 193h 194h 195h 196h 197h 198h 199h 19Ah 19Bh 19Ch 19Dh 19Eh 19Fh 1A0h Unimplemented 16Fh 170h 17Fh GPRs “gpr2s” (mirrors “gprnobank”) 1EFh 1F0h 1FFh FFh Legend: = Unimplemented data memory locations, read as ‘0’. DS40001709A-page 12 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 2-1: Addr Name PIC16F753/HV753 SPECIAL REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on POR/BOR Value on all other Resets Bank 0 00h INDF INDF<7:0> xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx 01h TMR0 TMR0<7:0> xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 02h PCL 03h STATUS PCL<7:0> PD IRP RP1 RP0 TO — — RA5 RA4 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 1xxx 000q quuu Z DC C RA2 RA1 RA0 --xx xxxx --uu uuuu 04h FSR 05h PORTA FSR<7:0> 06h — 07h PORTC — — RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 --xx xxxx --uu uuuu 08h IOCAF — — IOCAF5 IOCAF4 IOCAF3 IOCAF2 IOCAF1 IOCAF0 --00 0000 --00 0000 09h IOCCF — — IOCCF5 IOCCF4 IOCCF3 IOCCF2 IOCCF1 IOCCF0 --00 0000 --00 0000 RA3 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu Unimplemented — — 0Ah PCLATH — — — 0Bh INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF 0Ch PIR1 TMR1GIF ADIF — — HLTMR2IF HLTMR1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF 00--0000 0Dh PIR2 — — C2IF C1IF — COG1IF — CCP1IF --00 -0-0 --00 -0-0 0Eh — 0Fh TMR1L PCLATH<4:0> ---0 0000 ---0 0000 Unimplemented 10h TMR1H 11h T1CON 12h T1GCON 13h CCPR1L 14h CCPR1H TMR1GE T1GPOL T1GTM T1GSPM — xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu TMR1H<7:0> T1CKPS<1:0> 00--0000 — TMR1L<7:0> TMR1CS<1:0> 0000 0000 0000 0000 xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu T1OSCEN T1SYNC T1GGO/ DONE T1GVAL — TMR1ON T1GSS<1:0> 0000 00-0 0000 00-0 0000 0x00 0000 0x00 CCPR1L<7:0> xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu CCPR1H<7:0> xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 15h CCP1CON 16h — Unimplemented — — 17h — Unimplemented — — 18h — Unimplemented — — 19h — Unimplemented — — 1Ah — Unimplemented — — 1Bh — Unimplemented — — 1Ch ADRESL — DC1B<1:0> CCP1M<3:0> --00 0000 --00 0000 Least Significant two bits of the left shifted result or eight bits of the right shifted result 1Dh ADRESH 1Eh ADCON0 ADFM 1Fh ADCON1 — Legend: — Most Significant eight bits of the left shifted A/D result or two bits of the right shifted result — CHS<3:0> ADCS<2:0> — — xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu GO/DONE ADON 0-00 0000 0-00 0000 — ADPREF1 -000 ---0 -000 ---0 — = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition shaded = unimplemented. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 13 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 2-2: Addr PIC16F753/HV753 SPECIAL REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 1 Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE Bank 1 80h INDF 81h OPTION_REG 82h PCL 83h STATUS 84h FSR 85h TRISA Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 INDF<7:0> RP1 RP0 TO 1111 1111 1111 1111 PS<2:0> 0000 0000 0000 0000 PD Z DC C 0001 1xxx 000q quuu TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 --11 1111 --11 1111 TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 --11 1111 --11 1111 --00 0000 --00 0000 FSR — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISC5 TRISC4 Values on all other Resets xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu PSA PCL<7:0> IRP Value on POR/BOR xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 86h — 87h TRISC — — Unimplemented — 88h IOCAP — — IOCAP5 IOCAP4 IOCAP3 IOCAP2 IOCAP1 IOCAP0 89h IOCCP — — IOCCP5 IOCCP4 IOCCP3 IOCCP2 IOCCP1 IOCCP0 8Ah PCLATH — — — TRISC3 PCLATH<4:0> — --00 0000 --00 0000 ---0 0000 ---0 0000 8Bh INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 8Ch PIE1 TMR1GIE ADIE — — HLTMR2IE HLTMR1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 00-- 0000 00-- 0000 8Dh PIE2 — — C2IE C1IE — COG1IE — CCP1IE --00 -0-0 --00 -0-0 8Eh 8Fh — OSCCON HTS LTS 90h FVR1CON0 — — — FVRBUFEN 91h 92h DAC1CON0 DAC1REFL 93h DAC1REFH 94h — 95h — OPA1CON 96h 97h Unimplemented IRCF<1:0> — FVREN — FVRRDY DACEN DACFM DACOE — DACPSS1 DACPSS0 — Least Significant bit of the left shifted result or eight bits of the right shifted DAC setting FVROE FVRBUFSS1 — FVRBUFSS0 — Most Significant eight bits of the left shifted DAC setting or first bit of the right shifted result Unimplemented OPA1EN — — Unimplemented OPA1UGM OPA1NCH<1:0> OPA1PCH<1:0> — — --01 -00- --uu -uu0000 0--0 0000 0--0 000- 00-- 000- 00-0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 — — — — 0--0 0000 0--0 0000 — — Unimplemented Unimplemented — — — — 9Ah — — Unimplemented Unimplemented — — — — 9Bh 9Ch CM2CON0 CM2CON1 C2ON C2INTP C2OUT C2INTN C2OE C2POL C2PCH<2:0> C2ZLF C2SP C2HYS C2SYNC C2NCH<2:0> 0000 0100 0000 0100 0000 0000 0000 0000 9Dh 9Eh CM1CON0 CM1CON1 C1ON C1INTP C1OUT C1INTN C1OE C1POL C1PCH<2:0> C1ZLF C1SP C1HYS C1SYNC C1NCH<2:0> 0000 0100 0000 0100 0000 0000 0000 0000 98h 99h 9Fh CMOUT — — — — — — MCOUT2 MCOUT1 ---- --00 ---- --00 Legend: — = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition shaded = unimplemented. DS40001709A-page 14 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 2-3: Addr Name PIC16F753/HV753 SPECIAL REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on POR/BOR Value on all other Resets Bank 2 100h INDF INDF<7:0> xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx 101h TMR0 TMR0<7:0> xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 102h PCL 103h STATUS 104h FSR 105h LATA 106h — 107h LATC — — 108h IOCAN — — IOCAN5 IOCAN4 IOCAN3 IOCAN2 109h IOCCN — — IOCCN5 IOCCN4 IOCCN3 IOCCN2 10Ah PCLATH — — — 10Bh INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTF 10Ch WPUA — — WPUA5 WPUA4 WPUA3 WPUA2 10Dh WPUC — — WPUC5 WPUC4 WPUC3 WPUC2 10Eh SLRCONC — — SLRC5 SLRC4 — — 10Fh PCON — — — — — — PCL<7:0> IRP RP1 RP0 TO — — LATA5 LATA4 0000 0000 0000 0000 Z DC C — LATA2 LATA1 LATA0 --xx -xxx --uu -uuu LATC2 LATC1 LATC0 --xx xxxx --uu uuuu IOCAN1 IOCAN0 --00 0000 --00 0000 IOCCN1 IOCCN0 --00 0000 --00 0000 IOCIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 WPUA1 WPUA0 --11 1111 --11 1111 WPUC1 WPUC0 --11 1111 --11 1111 — — --00 ---- --00 ---- POR BOR FSR<7:0> xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu Unimplemented 110h TMR2 111h PR2 112h T2CON 113h HLTMR1 LATC5 LATC4 — — PCLATH<4:0> INTE IOCIE 1111 1111 1111 1111 TMR2ON T2CKPS<1:0> Holding Register for the 8-bit Hardware Limit Timer1 Count 114h HLTPR1 115h HLT1CON0 — 116h HLT1CON1 H1FES — -000 0000 -000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 HLTMR1 Module Period Register H1OUTPS<3:0> H1RES ---- --qq ---- --uu 0000 0000 0000 0000 PR2<7:0> T2OUTPS<3:0> — ---0 0000 ---0 0000 T0IF TMR2<7:0> — 0001 1xxx 000q quuu PD 1111 1111 1111 1111 H1ON H1ERS<2:0> H1CKPS<1:0> H1FEREN H1REREN -000 0000 -000 0000 11-0 0000 11-0 0000 117h HLTMR2 Holding Register for the 8-bit Hardware Limit Timer2 Count 0000 0000 0000 0000 118h HLTPR2 HLTMR2 Module Period Register 1111 1111 1111 1111 119h HLT2CON0 — 11Ah HLT2CON1 H2FES H2OUTPS<3:0> H2RES — H2ON H2ERS<2:0> H2CKPS<1:0> H2FEREN H2REREN -000 0000 -000 0000 11-0 0000 11-0 0000 11Bh — Unimplemented — — 11Ch — Unimplemented — — 11Dh — Unimplemented — — 11Eh SLPCCON0 SC1EN — — SC1POL 11Fh SLPCCON1 — — — SC1RNG Legend: SC1TSS1 SC1TSS0 — SC1ISET<3:0> SC1INS 0-00 00-0 0-00 00-0 ---0 0000 ---0 0000 — = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition shaded = unimplemented. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 15 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 2-4: Addr PIC16F753/HV753 SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS SUMMARY BANK 3 Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE IRP RP1 RP0 TO — — — ANSA4 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Value on POR/BOR Values on all other Resets Bank 3 180h INDF 181h OPTION_REG INDF<7:0> 182h PCL 183h STATUS 184h FSR 185h ANSELA 186h — 187h ANSELC — — — — ANSC3 188h APFCON — — — T1GSEL — 189h OSCTUNE — — — TUN<4:0> 18Ah PCLATH — — — PCLATH<4:0> 18Bh INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF 0000 0000 0000 0000 18Ch PMCON1 — — — — — WREN WR RD ---- -000 ---- -000 ---- ---- PSA PS<2:0> PCL<7:0> PD Z DC C — ANSA2 ANSA1 ANSA0 FSR<7:0> Unimplemented xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu 1111 1111 1111 1111 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 1xxx 000q quuu xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu ---1 -111 ---1 -111 — — ANSC2 ANSC1 ANSC0 ---- 0000 ---- 0000 — — — ---0 ---- ---0 ---- ---0 0000 ---0 0000 ---0 0000 ---0 0000 18Dh PMCON2 Program Memory Control Register 2 ---- ---- 18Eh PMADRL PMADRL<7:0> 0000 0000 0000 0000 ---- --00 0000 0000 ---- --00 0000 0000 18Fh 190h PMADRH PMDATL — — — — — PMDATL<7:0> — PMADRH<1:0> 191h 192h PMDATH COG1PHR — — — — — — G1PHR<3:0> --00 0000 ---- xxxx --00 0000 ---- uuuu 193h 194h COG1PHF COG1BKR — — — — — — — — G1PHF<3:0> G1BLKR<3:0> ---- xxxx ---- xxxx ---- uuuu ---- uuuu 195h 196h COG1BKF COG1DBR — — — — — — — — G1BLKF<3:0> G1DBR<3:0> ---- xxxx ---- xxxx ---- uuuu ---- uuuu 197h COG1DBF 198h COG1CON0 — G1EN — G1OE1 — G1OE0 — G1POL1 ---- xxxx ---- uuuu G1POL0 199h COG1CON1 G1RDBTS G1FDBTS — — — — — — G1RIHLT2 G1RMHLT2 G1RIHLT1 G1RMHLT1 G1RIT2M G1RMT2M G1RIFLT G1RMFLT G1RICCP1 G1RMCCP1 G1RIC2 G1RMC2 19Dh COG1FSIM — — G1FIHLT2 G1FMHLT2 G1FIHLT1 G1FMHLT1 G1FIT2M G1FMT2M G1FIFLT G1FMFLT G1FICCP1 G1FMCCP1 19Eh COG1ASD0 C1ASDE C1ARSEN PMDATH<5:0> G1DBF<3:0> G1LD — G1MD 0000 00-0 0000 00-0 00-- --00 00-- --00 G1RIC1 G1RMC1 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 G1FIC2 G1FMC2 G1FIC1 G1FMC1 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 — — 0000 00-- 0000 00-- — — — G1ASDSHLT2 G1ASDSHLT1 G1ASDSC2 G1ASDSC1 G1ASDSFLT 0000 0000 — = Unimplemented locations read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown, q = value depends on condition shaded = unimplemented 0000 0000 19Ah COG1RIS 19Bh COG1RSIM 19Ch COG1FIS G1ASD1L<1:0> G1ASD0L<1:0> G1CS<1:0> 19Fh COG1ASD1 Legend: DS40001709A-page 16 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 2.3 Global SFRs 2.3.1 writable. Therefore, the result of an instruction with the STATUS register as destination may be different than intended. STATUS REGISTER The STATUS register, shown in Register 2-1, contains: • the arithmetic status of the ALU • the Reset status • the bank select bits for data memory (RAM) The STATUS register can be the destination for any instruction, like any other register. If the STATUS register is the destination for an instruction that affects the Z, DC or C bits, then the write to these three bits is disabled. These bits are set or cleared according to the device logic. Furthermore, the TO and PD bits are not REGISTER 2-1: For example, CLRF STATUS, will clear the upper three bits and set the Z bit. This leaves the STATUS register as ‘000u u1uu’ (where u = unchanged). It is recommended, therefore, that only BCF, BSF, SWAPF and MOVWF instructions are used to alter the STATUS register, because these instructions do not affect any Status bits. For other instructions not affecting any Status bits, see Section 18.0 “Instruction Set Summary”. STATUS: STATUS REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R-1 R-1 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x IRP RP1 RP0 TO PD Z DC(1) C(1) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 IRP: Register Bank Select bit (used for indirect addressing) 1 = Bank 2, 3 (100h-1FFh) 0 = Bank 0, 1 (00h-FFh) bit 6 RP1: Register Bank Select bit (used for direct addressing) 00 = Bank 0 (00h-7Fh) 01 = Bank 1 (80h-FFh) 10 = Bank 2 (100h-17Fh) 11 = Bank 3 (180h-1FFh) bit 5 RP0: Register Bank Select bit (used for direct addressing) 1 = Bank 1 (80h-FFh) 0 = Bank 0 (00h-7Fh) bit 4 TO: Time-Out bit 1 = After power-up, CLRWDT instruction or SLEEP instruction 0 = A WDT time-out occurred bit 3 PD: Power-Down bit 1 = After power-up or by the CLRWDT instruction 0 = By execution of the SLEEP instruction bit 2 Z: Zero bit 1 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is zero 0 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is not zero bit 1 DC: Digit Carry/Borrow bit(2) (ADDWF, ADDLW,SUBLW,SUBWF instructions), For Borrow, the polarity is reversed. 1 = A carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result occurred 0 = No carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result bit 0 C: Carry/Borrow bit(2) (ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLW, SUBWF instructions) 1 = A carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred 0 = No carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred Note 1: 2: The C and DC bits operate as a Borrow and Digit Borrow out bit, respectively, in subtraction. See the SUBLW and SUBWF instructions for examples. For Borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the two’s complement of the second operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either the high-order or low-order bit of the source register. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 17 PIC16F753/HV753 2.3.2 OPTION REGISTER The OPTION register is a readable and writable register, which contains various control bits to configure: • • • • Note: Timer0/WDT prescaler External RA2/INT interrupt Timer0 Weak pull-ups on PORTA REGISTER 2-2: To achieve a 1:1 prescaler assignment for Timer0, assign the prescaler to the WDT by setting PSA bit to ‘1’ of the OPTION register. See Section 6.1.3 “Software Programmable Prescaler”. OPTION_REG: OPTION REGISTER R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 PS<2:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 RAPU: PORTA Pull-up Enable bit 1 = PORTA pull-ups are disabled 0 = PORTA pull-ups are enabled by individual PORT latch values bit 6 INTEDG: Interrupt Edge Select bit 1 = Interrupt on rising edge of INT pin 0 = Interrupt on falling edge of INT pin bit 5 T0CS: Timer0 Clock Source Select bit 1 = Transition on T0CKI pin 0 = Internal instruction cycle clock (FOSC/4) bit 4 T0SE: Timer0 Source Edge Select bit 1 = Increment on high-to-low transition on T0CKI pin 0 = Increment on low-to-high transition on T0CKI pin bit 3 PSA: Prescaler Assignment bit 1 = Prescaler is assigned to the WDT 0 = Prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module bit 2-0 PS<2:0>: Prescaler Rate Select bits BIT VALUE 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 DS40001709A-page 18 x = Bit is unknown TIMER0 RATE WDT RATE 1:2 1:4 1:8 1 : 16 1 : 32 1 : 64 1 : 128 1 : 256 1:1 1:2 1:4 1:8 1 : 16 1 : 32 1 : 64 1 : 128 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 2.3.3 INTCON REGISTER Note: The INTCON register is a readable and writable register, which contains the various enable and flag bits for TMR0 register overflow, IOCIE change and external RA2/INT pin interrupts. REGISTER 2-3: Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs, regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the Global Enable bit, GIE of the INTCON register. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. INTCON: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 GIE: Global Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables all unmasked interrupts 0 = Disables all interrupts bit 6 PEIE: Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables all unmasked peripheral interrupts 0 = Disables all peripheral interrupts bit 5 T0IE: Timer0 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Timer0 interrupt 0 = Disables the Timer0 interrupt bit 4 INTE: RA2/INT External Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the RA2/INT external interrupt 0 = Disables the RA2/INT external interrupt bit 3 IOCIE: Interrupt-on-Change Interrupt Enable bit(1) 1 = Enables the IOC change interrupt 0 = Disables the IOC change interrupt bit 2 T0IF: Timer0 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit(2) 1 = Timer0 register has overflowed (must be cleared in software) 0 = Timer0 register did not overflow bit 1 INTF: RA2/INT External Interrupt Flag bit 1 = The RA2/INT external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = The RA2/INT external interrupt did not occur bit 0 IOCIF: Interrupt-on-Change Interrupt Flag bit 1 = An IOC pin has changed state and generated an interrupt 0 = No pin interrupts have been generated Note 1: 2: IOC register must also be enabled. T0IF bit is set when TMR0 rolls over. TMR0 is unchanged on Reset and should be initialized before clearing T0IF bit. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 19 PIC16F753/HV753 2.3.4 PIE1 REGISTER The PIE1 register contains the Peripheral Interrupt Enable bits, as shown in Register 2-4. REGISTER 2-4: Note: Bit PEIE of the INTCON register must be set to enable any peripheral interrupt. PIE1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 1 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TMR1GIE ADIE — — HLTMR2IE HLTMR1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 TMR1GIE: ADC Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the TMR1 gate interrupt 0 = Disables the TMR1 gate interrupt bit 6 ADIE: ADC Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the ADC interrupt 0 = Disables the ADC interrupt bit 5-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 HLTMR2IE: HLT2 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the HLT2 interrupt 0 = Disables the HLT2 interrupt bit 2 HLTMR1IE: HLT1 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the HLT1 interrupt 0 = Disables the HLT1 interrupt bit 1 TMR2IE: Timer2 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Timer2 interrupt 0 = Disables the Timer2 interrupt bit 0 TMR1IE: Timer1 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Timer1 interrupt 0 = Disables the Timer1 interrupt DS40001709A-page 20 Preliminary x = Bit is unknown 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 2.3.5 PIE2 REGISTER The PIE2 register contains the Peripheral Interrupt Enable bits, as shown in Register 2-5. REGISTER 2-5: Note: Bit PEIE of the INTCON register must be set to enable any peripheral interrupt. PIE2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 1 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — C2IE C1IE — COG1IE — CCP1IE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5 C2IE: Comparator 2 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Comparator 2 interrupt 0 = Disables the Comparator 2 interrupt bit 4 C1IE: Comparator 1 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the Comparator 1 interrupt 0 = Disables the Comparator 1 interrupt bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2 COG1IE: COG 1 Interrupt Flag bit 1 = COG1 interrupt enabled 0 = COG1 interrupt disabled bit 1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 CCP1IE: CCP1 Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Enables the CCP1 interrupt 0 = Disables the CCP1 interrupt 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary x = Bit is unknown DS40001709A-page 21 PIC16F753/HV753 2.3.6 PIR1 REGISTER The PIR1 register contains the Peripheral Interrupt flag bits, as shown in Register 2-6. REGISTER 2-6: Note: Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs, regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the Global Enable bit, GIE of the INTCON register. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. PIR1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST REGISTER 1 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TMR1GIF ADIF — — HLTMR2IF HLTMR1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 TMR1GIF: TMR1 Gate Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Timer1 gate interrupt is pending 0 = Timer1 gate interrupt is not pending bit 6 ADIF: ADC Interrupt Flag bit 1 = ADC conversion complete 0 = ADC conversion has not completed or has not been started bit 5-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 HLTMR2IF: HLT2 to HLTPR2 Match Interrupt Flag bit 1 = HLT2 to HLTPR2 match occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = HLT2 to HLTPR2 match did not occur bit 2 HLTMR1IF: HLT1 to HLTPR1 Match Interrupt Flag bit 1 = HLT1 to HLTPR1 match occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = HLT1 to HLTPR1 match did not occur bit 1 TMR2IF: Timer2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Timer2 to PR2 match occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = Timer2 to PR2 match did not occur bit 0 TMR1IF: Timer1 Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Timer1 rolled over (must be cleared in software) 0 = Timer1 has not rolled over DS40001709A-page 22 Preliminary x = Bit is unknown 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 2.3.7 PIR2 REGISTER The PIR2 register contains the Peripheral Interrupt flag bits, as shown in Register 2-7. REGISTER 2-7: Note: Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs, regardless of the state of its corresponding enable bit or the Global Enable bit, GIE of the INTCON register. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. PIR2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST REGISTER 1 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — C2IF C1IF — COG1IF — CCP1IF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5 C2IF: Comparator 1 Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Comparator output (C2OUT bit) has changed (must be cleared in software) 0 = Comparator output (C2OUT bit) has not changed bit 4 C1IF: Comparator 1 Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Comparator output (C1OUT bit) has changed (must be cleared in software) 0 = Comparator output (C1OUT bit) has not changed bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2 COG1IF: COG 1 Interrupt Flag bit 1 = COG1 has generated an auto-shutdown interrupt 0 = COG1 has NOT generated an auto-shutdown interrupt bit 1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 CCP1IF: ECCP Interrupt Flag bit Capture Mode 1 = A TMR1 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = No TMR1 register capture occurred Compare Mode 1 = A TMR1 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software) 0 = No TMR1 register compare match occurred PWM mode Unused in this mode 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 23 PIC16F753/HV753 2.3.8 PCON REGISTER The Power Control (PCON) register (see Table 19-2) contains flag bits to differentiate between a: • • • • Power-on Reset (POR) Brown-out Reset (BOR) Watchdog Timer Reset (WDT) External MCLR Reset The PCON register also controls the software enable of the BOR. The PCON register bits are shown in Register 2-8. REGISTER 2-8: PCON: POWER CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-q/u R/W-q/u — — — — — — POR BOR bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = unchanged bit 7-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 POR: Power-on Reset Status bit 1 = No Power-on Reset occurred 0 = A Power-on Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset occurs) bit 0 BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit 1 = No Brown-out Reset occurred 0 = A Brown-out Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Brown-out Reset occurs) DS40001709A-page 24 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 2.4 PCL and PCLATH 2.4.2 The Program Counter (PC) is 13 bits wide. The low byte comes from the PCL register, which is a readable and writable register. The high byte (PC<12:8>) is not directly readable or writable and comes from PCLATH. On any Reset, the PC is cleared. Figure 2-3 shows the two situations for the loading of the PC. The upper example in Figure 2-3 shows how the PC is loaded on a write to PCL (PCLATH<4:0> PCH). The lower example in Figure 2-3 shows how the PC is loaded during a CALL or GOTO instruction (PCLATH<4:3> PCH). FIGURE 2-3: LOADING OF PC IN DIFFERENT SITUATIONS PCH PCL 12 8 7 0 PC The PIC16F753/HV753 Family has an 8-level x 13-bit wide hardware stack (see Figure 2-1). The stack space is not part of either program or data space and the Stack Pointer is not readable or writable. The PC is PUSHed onto the stack when a CALL instruction is executed or an interrupt causes a branch. The stack is POPed in the event of a RETURN, RETLW or a RETFIE instruction execution. PCLATH is not affected by a PUSH or POP operation. The stack operates as a circular buffer. This means that after the stack has been PUSHed eight times, the ninth push overwrites the value that was stored from the first push. The tenth push overwrites the second push (and so on). Note 1: There are no Status bits to indicate Stack Overflow or Stack Underflow conditions. 2: There are no instructions/mnemonics called PUSH or POP. These are actions that occur from the execution of the CALL, RETURN, RETLW and RETFIE instructions or the vectoring to an interrupt address. 8 PCLATH<4:0> 5 Instruction with PCL as Destination ALU Result PCLATH PCH 12 11 10 PCL 8 0 7 PC GOTO, CALL 2 PCLATH<4:3> 11 2.5 OPCODE <10:0> Indirect Addressing, INDF and FSR Registers The INDF register is not a physical register. Addressing the INDF register will cause indirect addressing. PCLATH 2.4.1 STACK MODIFYING PCL Executing any instruction with the PCL register as the destination simultaneously causes the Program Counter PC<12:8> bits (PCH) to be replaced by the contents of the PCLATH register. This allows the entire contents of the program counter to be changed by writing the desired upper five bits to the PCLATH register. When the lower eight bits are written to the PCL register, all 13 bits of the program counter will change to the values contained in the PCLATH register and those being written to the PCL register. A computed GOTO is accomplished by adding an offset to the program counter (ADDWF PCL). Care should be exercised when jumping into a look-up table or program branch table (computed GOTO) by modifying the PCL register. Assuming that PCLATH is set to the table start address, if the table length is greater than 255 instructions or if the lower eight bits of the memory address rolls over from 0xFF to 0x00 in the middle of the table, then PCLATH must be incremented for each address rollover that occurs between the table beginning and the target location within the table. Indirect addressing is possible by using the INDF register. Any instruction using the INDF register actually accesses data pointed to by the File Select Register (FSR). Reading INDF itself indirectly will produce 00h. Writing to the INDF register indirectly results in a no operation (although Status bits may be affected). An effective 9-bit address is obtained by concatenating the 8-bit FSR and the IRP bit of the STATUS register, as shown in Figure 2-4. A simple program to clear RAM location 40h-7Fh using indirect addressing is shown in Example 2-1. EXAMPLE 2-1: MOVLW MOVWF NEXT CLRF INCF BTFSS GOTO CONTINUE INDIRECT ADDRESSING 0x40 FSR INDF FSR FSR,7 NEXT ;initialize pointer ;to RAM ;clear INDF register ;inc pointer ;all done? ;no clear next ;yes continue For more information refer to Application Note AN556, “Implementing a Table Read” (DS00556). 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 25 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 2-4: DIRECT/INDIRECT ADDRESSING PIC16F753/HV753 Direct Addressing RP1 RP0 Bank Select From Opcode 6 Indirect Addressing 0 IRP 7 Bank Select Location Select 00 01 10 File Select Register 0 Location Select 11 00h 180h Data Memory 7Fh 1FFh Bank 0 Bank 1 Bank 2 Bank 3 For memory map detail, see Figure 2-2. DS40001709A-page 26 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 3.0 FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY SELF READ/SELF WRITE CONTROL 3.1 PMADRH and PMADRL Registers The PMADRH and PMADRL registers can address up to a maximum of 1K words of program memory. The Flash program memory is readable and writable during normal operation (full VDD range). This memory is not directly mapped in the register file space. Instead, it is indirectly addressed through the Special Function Registers (see Registers 3-1 to 3-5). There are six SFRs used to read and write this memory: When selecting a program address value, the Most Significant Byte (MSB) of the address is written to the PMADRH register and the Least Significant Byte (LSB) is written to the PMADRL register. • • • • • • PMCON1 is the control register for the data program memory accesses. PMCON1 PMCON2 PMDATL PMDATH PMADRL PMADRH When interfacing the program memory block, the PMDATL and PMDATH registers form a two-byte word which holds the 14-bit data for read/write, and the PMADRL and PMADRH registers form a two-byte word which holds the 10-bit address of the Flash location being accessed. These devices have 1K words of program Flash with an address range from 0000h to 03FFh. 3.2 PMCON1 and PMCON2 Registers Control bits RD and WR initiate read and write, respectively. These bits cannot be cleared, only set in software. They are cleared in hardware at completion of the read or write operation. The inability to clear the WR bit in software prevents the accidental premature termination of a write operation. The WREN bit, when set, will allow a write operation. On power-up, the WREN bit is clear. PMCON2 is not a physical register. Reading PMCON2 will read all ‘0’s. The PMCON2 register is used exclusively in the Flash memory write sequence. The program memory allows a single-word read and a four-word write. A four-word write automatically erases the row of the location and writes the new data (erase before write). The write time is controlled by an on-chip timer. The write/erase voltages are generated by an on-chip charge pump rated to operate over the voltage range of the device for byte or word operations. When the device is code-protected, the CPU may continue to read and write the Flash program memory. Depending on the settings of the Flash Program Memory Enable (WRT<1:0>) bits, the device may or may not be able to write certain blocks of the program memory; however, reads of the program memory are allowed. When the Flash program memory Code Protection (CP) bit in the Configuration Word register is enabled, the program memory is code-protected, and the device programmer (ICSP™) cannot access data or program memory. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 27 PIC16F753/HV753 3.3 Register Definitions: Flash Program Memory Control REGISTER 3-1: R/W-0 PMDATL: PROGRAM MEMORY DATA LOW BYTE REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PMDATL<7:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 x = Bit is unknown PMDATL<7:0>: Eight Least Significant Data bits to Write or Read from Program Memory REGISTER 3-2: R/W-0 PMADRL: PROGRAM MEMORY ADDRESS LOW BYTE REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PMADRL<7:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 x = Bit is unknown PMADRL<7:0>: Eight Least Significant Address bits for Program Memory Read/Write Operation REGISTER 3-3: PMDATH: PROGRAM MEMORY DATA HIGH BYTE REGISTER U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PMDATH<5:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 PMDATH<5:0>: Six Most Significant Data bits from Program Memory REGISTER 3-4: PMADRH: PROGRAM MEMORY ADDRESS HIGH BYTE REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 PMADRH<1:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1-0 PMADRH<1:0>: Specifies the two Most Significant Address bits or High bits for Program Memory Reads. DS40001709A-page 28 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 3-5: PMCON1: PROGRAM MEMORY CONTROL 1 REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 R/S/HC-0/0 R/S/HC-0/0 — — — — — WREN WR RD bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ S = Bit can only be set x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared HC = Bit is cleared by hardware bit 7-3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2 WREN: Program/Erase Enable bit 1 = Allows program/erase cycles 0 = Inhibits programming/erasing of program Flash bit 1 WR: Write Control bit 1 = Initiates a program Flash program/erase operation The operation is self-timed and the bit is cleared by hardware once operation is complete. The WR bit can only be set (not cleared) in software. 0 = Program/erase operation to the Flash is complete and inactive bit 0 RD: Read Control bit 1 = Initiates a program Flash read. Read takes one cycle. RD is cleared in hardware. The RD bit can only be set (not cleared) in software. 0 = Does not initiate a program Flash read REGISTER 3-6: W-0/0 PMCON2: PROGRAM MEMORY CONTROL 2 REGISTER W-0/0 W-0/0 W-0/0 W-0/0 W-0/0 W-0/0 W-0/0 Program Memory Control Register 2 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ S = Bit can only be set x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 Flash Memory Unlock Pattern bits: To unlock writes, a 55h must be written first, followed by an AAh, before setting the WR bit of the PMCON1 register. The value written to this register is used to unlock the writes. There are specific timing requirements on these writes. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 29 PIC16F753/HV753 3.4 Reading the Flash Program Memory To read a program memory location, the user must write two bytes of the address to the PMADRL and PMADRH registers, and then set control bit RD (PMCON1<0>). Once the read control bit is set, the program memory Flash controller will use the second instruction cycle after to read the data. This causes the second instruction immediately following the “BSF PMCON1,RD” instruction to be ignored. The data is available in the very next cycle in the PMDATL and PMDATH registers; it can be read as two bytes in the following instructions. PMDATL and PMDATH registers will hold this value until another read or until it is written to by the user (during a write operation). EXAMPLE 3-1: BANKSEL MOVLW MOVWF MOVLW MOVWF BANKSEL BSF FLASH PROGRAM READ PM_ADR MS_PROG_PM_ADDR PMADRH LS_PROG_PM_ADDR PMADRL PMCON1 PMCON1, RD ; ; ; ; ; ; ; Change STATUS bits RP1:0 to select bank with PMADRL MS Byte of Program Address to read LS Byte of Program Address to read Bank to containing PMCON1 PM Read NOP ; First instruction after BSF PMCON1,RD executes normally NOP ; ; ; ; ; ; BANKSEL MOVF MOVF PMDATL PMDATL, W PMDATH, W DS40001709A-page 30 Any instructions here are ignored as program memory is read in second cycle after BSF PMCON1,RD Bank to containing PMADRL W = LS Byte of Program PMDATL W = MS Byte of Program PMDATL Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 3-1: FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY READ CYCLE EXECUTION Q1 Flash ADDR Q2 Q3 Q4 PC Flash DATA Q1 Q2 Q4 PC + 1 INSTR (PC) INSTR (PC - 1) Executed here Q3 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 PMADRH,PMADRL INSTR (PC + 1) BSF PMCON1,RD Executed here Q2 Q3 PC+3 PC +3 PMDATH,PMDATL INSTR (PC + 1) Executed here Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 NOP Executed here Q2 Q3 Q4 PC + 5 PC + 4 INSTR (PC + 3) Q1 INSTR (PC + 4) INSTR (PC + 3) Executed here INSTR (PC + 4) Executed here RD bit PMDATH PMDATL Register PMRHLT 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 31 PIC16F753/HV753 3.5 Writing the Flash Program Memory A word of the Flash program memory may only be written to if the word is in an unprotected segment of memory. Flash program memory must be written in four-word blocks. See Figure 3-2 and Figure 3-3 for more details. A block consists of four words with sequential addresses, with a lower boundary defined by an address, where PMADRL<1:0> = 00. All block writes to program memory are done as 16-word erase by fourword write operations. The write operation is edgealigned and cannot occur across boundaries. To write program data, it must first be loaded into the buffer registers (see Figure 3-2). This is accomplished by first writing the destination address to PMADRL and PMADRH and then writing the data to PMDATL and PMDATH. After the address and data have been set up, then the following sequence of events must be executed: 1. 2. Write 55h, then AAh, to PMCON2 (Flash programming sequence). Set the WR control bit of the PMCON1 register. All four buffer register locations should be written to with correct data. If less than four words are being written to in the block of four words, then a read from the program memory location(s) not being written to must be performed. This takes the data from the program location(s) not being written and loads it into the PMDATL and PMDATH registers. Then the sequence of events to transfer data to the buffer registers must be executed. which the erase takes place (i.e., the last word of the sixteen-word block erase). This is not Sleep mode as the clocks and peripherals will continue to run. After the four-word write cycle, the processor will resume operation with the third instruction after the PMCON1 write instruction. The above sequence must be repeated for the higher 12 words. 3.6 Protection Against Spurious Write There are conditions when the device should not write to the program memory. To protect against spurious writes, various mechanisms have been built in. On power-up, WREN is cleared. Also, the Power-up Timer (64 ms duration) prevents program memory writes. The write initiate sequence and the WREN bit help prevent an accidental write during brown-out, power glitch or software malfunction. 3.7 Operation During Code-Protect When the device is code-protected, the CPU is able to read and write unscrambled data to the program memory. 3.8 Operation During Write Protect When the program memory is write-protected, the CPU can read and execute from the program memory. The portions of program memory that are write-protected can be modified by the CPU using the PMCON registers, but the protected program memory cannot be modified using ICSP mode. To transfer data from the buffer registers to the program memory, the PMADRL and PMADRH must point to the last location in the four-word block (PMADRL<1:0> = 11). Then the following sequence of events must be executed: 1. 2. Write 55h, then AAh, to PMCON2 (Flash programming sequence). Set control bit WR of the PMCON1 register to begin the write operation. The user must follow the same specific sequence to initiate the write for each word in the program block, writing each program word in sequence (000, 001, 010, 011). When the write is performed on the last word (PMADRL<1:0> = 11), a block of sixteen words is automatically erased and the content of the four-word buffer registers are written into the program memory. After the “BSF PMCON1,WR” instruction, the processor requires two cycles to set up the erase/write operation. The user must place two NOP instructions after the WR bit is set. Since data is being written to buffer registers, the writing of the first three words of the block appears to occur immediately. The processor will halt internal operations for the typical 4 ms, only during the cycle in DS40001709A-page 32 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 3-2: BLOCK WRITES TO 1K FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY 7 5 0 0 7 PMDATH If at a new row sixteen words of Flash are erased, then four buffers are transferred to Flash automatically after this word is written PMDATL 6 8 14 14 First word of block to be written 14 PMADRL<1:0> = 00 PMADRL<1:0> = 10 PMADRL<1:0> = 01 Buffer Register Buffer Register 14 PMADRL<1:0> = 11 Buffer Register Buffer Register Program Memory FIGURE 3-3: FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY LONG WRITE CYCLE EXECUTION Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 PMADRH,PMADRL PC + 1 Flash ADDR INSTR (PC) Flash DATA Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 INSTR (PC + 1) ignored read BSF PMCON1,WR INSTR (PC + 1) Executed here Executed here PMDATH,PMDATL Processor halted PM Write Time PC + 2 PC + 3 INSTR (PC+2) NOP Executed here PC + 4 INSTR (PC+3) (INSTR (PC + 2) NOP INSTR (PC + 3) Executed here Executed here Flash Memory Location WR bit PMWHLT 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 33 PIC16F753/HV753 An example of the complete four-word write sequence is shown in Example 3-2. The initial address is loaded into the PMADRH and PMADRL register pair; the four words of data are loaded using indirect addressing. EXAMPLE 3-2: WRITING TO FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; This write routine assumes the following: ; A valid starting address (the least significant bits = '00') ; is loaded in ADDRH:ADDRL ; ADDRH, ADDRL and DATADDR are all located in data memory ; BANKSEL PMADRH MOVF ADDRH,W ;Load initial address MOVWF PMADRH ; MOVF ADDRL,W ; MOVWF PMADRL ; MOVF DATAADDR,W ;Load initial data address MOVWF FSR ; LOOP MOVF INDF,W ;Load first data byte into lower MOVWF PMDATL ; INCF FSR,F ;Next byte MOVF INDF,W ;Load second data byte into upper MOVWF PMDATH ; INCF FSR,F ; BANKSEL PMCON1 BSF PMCON1,WREN ;Enable writes BCF INTCON,GIE ;Disable interrupts (if using) BTFSC INTCON,GIE ;See AN576 GOTO $-2 ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; ; Required Sequence MOVLW 55h ;Start of required write sequence: MOVWF PMCON2 ;Write 55h MOVLW 0AAh ; MOVWF PMCON2 ;Write 0AAh BSF PMCON1,WR ;Set WR bit to begin write NOP ;Required to transfer data to the buffer NOP ;registers ;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;;; BCF PMCON1,WREN ;Disable writes BSF INTCON,GIE ;Enable interrupts (comment out if not using interrupts) BANKSEL PMADRL MOVF PMADRL, W INCF PMADRL,F ;Increment address ANDLW 0x03 ;Indicates when sixteen words have been programmed SUBLW 0x03 ;Change value for different size write blocks ;0x0F = 16 words ;0x0B = 12 words ;0x07 = 8 words ;0x03 = 4 words BTFSS STATUS,Z ;Exit on a match, GOTO LOOP ;Continue if more data needs to be written DS40001709A-page 34 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 3-1: Name SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page — — — — — WREN WR RD 29 PMCON1 PMCON2 Program Memory Control Register 2 29 PMADRL PMADRL<7:0> 28 PMADRH — — — — PMDATL PMDATH — — INTCON GIE PEIE Legend: * CONFIG(1) Legend: Note 1: — PMADRH<1:0> 28 PMDATH<5:0> T0IE INTE 28 IOCIE 28 T0IF INTF IOCIF 19 — = unimplemented location, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by Flash program memory module. Page provides register information. TABLE 3-2: Name — PMDATL<7:0> SUMMARY OF CONFIGURATION WORD WITH FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY Bits Bit -/7 Bit -/6 Bit 13/5 Bit 12/4 13:8 7:0 — — DEBUG CLKOUTEN — CP MCLRE PWRTE Bit 11/3 Bit 10/2 WRT<1:0> WDTE Bit 9/1 Bit 8/0 BOREN<1:0> — — FOSC0 Register on Page 162 — = unimplemented location, read as ‘1’. Shaded cells are not used by Flash program memory. See Configuration Word register (Register 19-1) for operation of all register bits. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 35 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 36 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 4.0 OSCILLATOR MODULE The internal oscillator module provides the following selectable system clock modes: 4.1 Overview • • • • The oscillator module has a variety of clock sources and selection features that allow it to be used in a wide range of applications while maximizing performance and minimizing power consumption. Figure 4-1 illustrates a block diagram of the oscillator module. 8 MHz (HFINTOSC) 4 MHz (HFINTOSC Postscaler) 1 MHz (HFINTOSC Postscaler) 31 kHz (LFINTOSC) The oscillator module can be configured in one of two clock modes. 1. 2. EC (external clock) INTOSC (internal oscillator) Clock Source modes are configured by the FOSC bit in the Configuration Word register (CONFIG). FIGURE 4-1: PIC® MCU CLOCK SOURCE BLOCK DIAGRAM EC Enable (Figure 4-2) EC CLKIN HFINTOSC Enable (Figure 4-2) LFINTOSC Enable (Figure 4-2) HFINTOSC 8 MHz Prescaler ÷1 11 ÷2 10 ÷8 01 LFINTOSC 31 kHz MUX Internal Oscillator 1 System Clock (CPU and Peripherals) 0 FOSC 00 IRCF<1:0> COG Clock Source WDT Clock Source FIGURE 4-2: OSCILLATOR ENABLE FOSC0 Sleep FOSC0 IRCF<1:0> 00 Sleep EC Enable HFINTOSC Enable FOSC0 IRCF<1:0> = 00 Sleep LFINTOSC Enable WDTE 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 37 PIC16F753/HV753 4.2 Clock Source Modes 4.2.2 Clock Source modes can be classified as external or internal: • The External Clock mode relies on an external clock for the clock source. For example, a clock module or clock output from another circuit. • Internal clock sources are contained internally within the oscillator module. The oscillator module has four selectable clock frequencies: - 8 MHz - 4 MHz - 1 MHz - 31 kHz The system clock can be selected between external or internal clock sources via the FOSC0 bit of the Configuration Word register (CONFIG). 4.2.1 EC MODE The External Clock (EC) mode allows an externally generated logic as the system clock source. The EC clock mode is selected when the FOSC0 bit of the Configuration Word is set. Internal Clock mode configures the internal oscillators as the system clock source. The Internal Clock mode is selected when the FOSC0 bit of the Configuration Word is cleared. The source and frequency are selected with the IRCF<1:0> bits of the OSCCON register. When one of the HFINTOSC frequencies is selected, the frequency of the internal oscillator can be trimmed by adjusting the TUN<4:0> bits of the OSCTUNE register. Operation after a Power-on Reset (POR) or wake-up from Sleep is delayed by the oscillator start-up time. Delays are typically longer for the LFINTOSC than HFINTOSC because of the very low-power operation and relatively narrow bandwidth of the LF internal oscillator. However, when another peripheral keeps the oscillator running during Sleep, the start-up time is delayed to allow the memory bias to stabilize. FIGURE 4-4: When operating in this mode, an external clock source must be connected to the CLKIN input. The CLKOUT is available for either general purpose I/O or system clock output. Figure 4-3 shows the pin connections for EC mode. Because the PIC® MCU design is fully static, stopping the external clock input will have the effect of halting the device while leaving all data intact. Upon restarting the external clock, the device will resume operation as if no time had elapsed. FIGURE 4-3: EXTERNAL CLOCK (EC) MODE OPERATION INTERNAL CLOCK MODE OPERATION I/O CLKIN(1) PIC® MCU I/O Note 1: 4.2.2.1 CLKOUT(1) Alternate pin functions are listed in Section 1.0 “Device Overview”. Oscillator Ready Bits The HTS and LTS bits of the OSCCON register indicate the status of the HFINTOSC and LFINTOSC, respectively. When either bit is set, it indicates that the corresponding oscillator is running and stable. CLKIN Clock from Ext. System PIC® MCU I/O Note 1: INTERNAL CLOCK MODE CLKOUT(1) Alternate pin functions are listed in Section 1.0 “Device Overview”. DS40001709A-page 38 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 4.3 System Clock Output 4.4 The CLKOUT pin is available for general purpose I/O or system clock output. The CLKOUTEN bit of the Configuration Word controls the function of the CLKOUT pin. When the CLKOUTEN bit is cleared, the CLKOUT pin is driven by the selected internal oscillator frequency divided by 4. The corresponding I/O pin always reads ‘0’ in this configuration. The CLKOUT signal may be used to provide a clock for external circuitry, synchronization, calibration, test or other application requirements. When the CLKOUTEN bit is set, the system clock out function is disabled and the CLKOUT pin is available for general purpose I/O. TABLE 4-1: Oscillator Delay upon Wake-Up, Power-Up, and Base Frequency Change In applications where the OSCTUNE register is used to shift the HFINTOSC frequency, the application should not expect the frequency to stabilize immediately. In this case, the frequency may shift gradually toward the new value. The time for this frequency shift is less than eight cycles of the base frequency. A short delay is invoked upon power-up and when waking from sleep to allow the memory bias circuitry to stabilize. Table 4-1 shows examples where the oscillator delay is invoked. OSCILLATOR DELAY EXAMPLES Switch From Switch To Frequency Oscillator Delay Sleep/POR INTOSC 31 kHz to 8 MHz Sleep/POR EC DC – 20 MHz 10 s internal delay to allow memory bias to stabilize. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 39 PIC16F753/HV753 4.5 Register Definitions: Oscillator Control REGISTER 4-1: OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0/u R/W-1/u IRCF<1:0> U-0 R-0/u R-0/u U-0 — HTS LTS — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-4 IRCF<1:0>: Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits 11 = 8 MHz 10 = 4 MHz 01 = 1 MHz (Reset default) 00 = 31 kHz (LFINTOSC) bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2 HTS: HFINTOSC Status bit 1 = HFINTOSC is stable 0 = HFINTOSC is not stable bit 1 LTS: LFINTOSC Status bit 1 = LFINTOSC is stable 0 = LFINTOSC is not stable bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DS40001709A-page 40 Preliminary x = Bit is unknown 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 4.5.1 OSCTUNE REGISTER The default value of the OSCTUNE register is ‘0’. The value is a 5-bit two’s complement number. The oscillator is factory calibrated, but can be adjusted in software by writing to the OSCTUNE register (Register 4-2). REGISTER 4-2: When the OSCTUNE register is modified, the frequency will begin shifting to the new frequency. Code execution continues during this shift. There is no indication that the shift has occurred. OSCTUNE: OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R/W-0/u R/W-0/u R/W-0/u R/W-0/u R/W-0/u TUN<4:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4-0 TUN<4:0>: Frequency Tuning bits 01111 = Maximum frequency 01110 = • • • 00001 = 00000 = Oscillator module is running at the calibrated frequency. 11111 = • • • 10000 = Minimum frequency TABLE 4-2: Name SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH CLOCK SOURCES Bit 7 Bit 6 OSCCON — — OSCTUNE — — Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page — HTS LTS — 40 IRCF<1:0> — TUN<4:0> 41 Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by oscillators. TABLE 4-3: Name CONFIG(1) Legend: Note 1: SUMMARY OF CONFIGURATION WORD CLOCK SOURCES Bits Bit -/7 Bit -/6 Bit 13/5 Bit 12/4 13:8 7:0 — — DEBUG CLKOUTEN — CP MCLRE PWRTE Bit 11/3 Bit 10/2 Bit 9/1 WRT<1:0> WDTE Bit 8/0 BOREN<1:0> — — FOSC0 Register on Page 162 — = unimplemented location, read as ‘1’. Shaded cells are not used by oscillator module. See Configuration Word register (Register 19-1) for operation of all register bits. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 41 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 42 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 5.0 I/O PORTS EXAMPLE 5-1: Depending on the device selected and peripherals enabled, there are up to two ports available. In general, when a peripheral is enabled, that pin may not be used as a general purpose I/O pin. Each port has three standard registers for its operation. These registers are: • TRISx registers (data direction) • PORTx registers (reads the levels on the pins of the device) • LATx registers (output latch) Some ports may have one or more of the following additional registers. These registers are: ; ; ; ; INITIALIZING PORTA This code example illustrates initializing the PORTA register. The other ports are initialized in the same manner. BANKSEL CLRF BANKSEL CLRF BANKSEL CLRF BANKSEL MOVLW MOVWF PORTA PORTA LATA LATA ANSELA ANSELA TRISA B'00111000' TRISA ; ;Init PORTA ;Data Latch ; ; ;digital I/O ; ;Set RA<5:3> as inputs ;and set RA<2:0> as ;outputs • ANSELx (analog select) • WPUx (weak pull-up) • INLVLx (input level control) The Data Latch (LATx registers) is useful for readmodify-write operations on the values that the I/O pins are driving. A write operation to the LATx register has the same affect as a write to the corresponding PORTx register. A read of the LATx register reads the values held in the I/O PORT latches, while a read of the PORTx register reads the actual I/O pin value. Ports with analog functions also have an ANSELx register which can disable the digital input and save power. A simplified model of a generic I/O port, without the interfaces to other peripherals, is shown in Figure 5-1. FIGURE 5-1: GENERIC I/O PORTA OPERATION Read LATA D Write LATA Write PORTA TRISA Q CK VDD Data Register Data Bus I/O pin Read PORTA To peripherals ANSELA 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. VSS Preliminary DS40001709A-page 43 PIC16F753/HV753 5.1 Alternate Pin Function The Alternate Pin Function Control (APFCON) register is used to steer specific peripheral input and output functions between different pins. The APFCON register is shown in Register 5-1. For this device family, the following functions can be moved between different pins. • Timer1 Gate • COG1 These bits have no effect on the values of any TRIS register. PORT and TRIS overrides will be routed to the correct pin. The unselected pin will be unaffected. 5.2 Register Definitions: Alternate Pin Function Control REGISTER 5-1: APFCON: ALTERNATE PIN FUNCTION CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — T1GSEL — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’. bit 4 T1GSEL: Timer 1 Gate Input Pin Selection bit 1 = T1G function is on RA3 0 = T1G function is on RA4 bit 3-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’. DS40001709A-page 44 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 5.3 PORTA and TRISA Registers PORTA is a 6-bit wide port with five bidirectional and one input-only pin. The corresponding data direction register is TRISA (Register 5-2). Setting a TRISA bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTA pin an input (i.e., disable the output driver). Clearing a TRISA bit (= 0) will make the corresponding PORTA pin an output (i.e., enables output driver and puts the contents of the output latch on the selected pin). The exception is RA3, which is input-only and its TRIS bit will always read as ‘1’. Example 5-1 shows how to initialize PORTA. TABLE 5-1: Reading the PORTA register (Register 5-2) reads the status of the pins, whereas writing to it will write to the PORT latch. All write operations are read-modify-write operations. Therefore, a write to a port implies that the port pins are read, this value is modified and then written to the PORT data latch. RA3 reads ‘0’ when MCLRE = 1. The TRISA register controls the direction of the PORTA pins, even when they are being used as analog inputs. The user must ensure the bits in the TRISA register are maintained set when using them as analog inputs. I/O pins configured as analog input always read ‘0’. Note: 5.3.1 The ANSEL register must be initialized to configure an analog channel as a digital input. Pins configured as analog inputs will read ‘0’ and cannot generate an interrupt. Pin Name PORTA OUTPUT PRIORITY Function Priority RA0 ICSPDAT FVROUT DACOUT C1IN0+ RA0 RA1 FVRIN ICSPCLK VREF C1IN0C2IN0RA1 RA2 COG1FLT T0CKI C1OUT INT RA2 RA3 MCLR VPP T1G RA3 RA4 CLKOUT T1G RA4 RA5 CLKIN T1CKI RA5 PORTA FUNCTIONS AND OUTPUT PRIORITIES Each PORTA pin is multiplexed with other functions. The pins, their combined functions and their output priorities are shown in Table 5-1. When multiple outputs are enabled, the actual pin control goes to the peripheral with the highest priority. Analog input functions, such as comparator inputs, are not shown in the priority lists. These inputs are active when the peripheral is enabled and the input multiplexer for the pin is selected. The Analog mode, set with the ANSELA register, disables the digital input buffer thereby preventing excessive input current when the analog input voltage is between logic states. Digital output functions may control the pin when it is in Analog mode with the priority shown in Table 5-1. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 45 PIC16F753/HV753 5.4 Register Definitions: PORTA Control REGISTER 5-2: PORTA: PORTA REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R-x/x R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u — — RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 RA<5:0>: PORTA I/O Value bits(1) 1 = Port pin is > VIH 0 = Port pin is < VIL Note 1: Writes to PORTA are actually written to corresponding LATA register. Reads from PORTA register is return of actual I/O pin values. REGISTER 5-3: TRISA: PORTA TRI-STATE REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-1/1 R/W-1/1 R-1/1 R/W-1/1 R/W-1/1 R/W-1/1 — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3(1) TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 TRISA<5:0>: PORTA Tri-State Control bits(1) 1 = PORTA pin configured as an input (tri-stated) 0 = PORTA pin configured as an output Note 1: TRISA3 always reads ‘1’. REGISTER 5-4: LATA: PORTA DATA LATCH REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-x/u R/W-x/u U-0 R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u — — LATA5 LATA4 — LATA2 LATA1 LATA0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-4 LATA<5:4>: PORTA Output Latch Value bits(1) bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2-0 LATA<2:0>: PORTA Output Latch Value bits(1) Note 1: Writes to PORTA are actually written to corresponding LATA register. Reads from PORTA register is return of actual I/O pin values. DS40001709A-page 46 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 5.5 Additional Pin Functions 5.5.3 Every PORTA pin on the PIC16F753 has an interrupton-change option and a weak pull-up option. The next three sections describe these functions. 5.5.1 ANSELA REGISTER INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE Each PORTA pin is individually configurable as an interrupt-on-change pin. Control bits IOCA enable or disable the interrupt function for each pin. Refer to Register 5-7. The interrupt-on-change is disabled on a Power-on Reset. The ANSELA register (Register 5-5) is used to configure the Input mode of an I/O pin to analog. Setting the appropriate ANSELA bit high will cause all digital reads on the pin to be read as ‘0’ and allow analog functions on the pin to operate correctly. For enabled interrupt-on-change pins, the values are compared with the old value latched on the last read of PORTA. The ‘mismatch’ outputs of the last read are OR’d together to set the PORTA Change Interrupt Flag bit (IOCIF) in the INTCON register (Register 2-3). The state of the ANSELA bits has no effect on digital output functions. A pin with TRIS clear and ANSEL set will still operate as a digital output, but the Input mode will be analog. This can cause unexpected behavior when executing read-modify-write instructions on the affected port. This interrupt can wake the device from Sleep. The user, in the Interrupt Service Routine, clears the interrupt by: Note: 5.5.2 The ANSELA bits default to the Analog mode after Reset. To use any pins as digital general purpose or peripheral inputs, the corresponding ANSEL bits must be initialized to ‘0’ by user software. WEAK PULL-UPS Each of the PORTA pins, except RA3, has an individually configurable internal weak pull-up. Control bits WPUx enable or disable each pull-up. Refer to Register 5-6. Each weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are disabled on a Power-on Reset by the RAPU bit of the OPTION_REG register. A weak pull-up is automatically enabled for RA3 when configured as MCLR and disabled when RA3 is an I/O. There is no software control of the MCLR pull-up. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. a) Any read of PORTA AND Clear flag bit IOCIF. This will end the mismatch condition; OR b) Any write of PORTA AND Clear flag bit IOCIF will end the mismatch condition; A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit IOCIF. Reading PORTA will end the mismatch condition and allow flag bit IOCIF to be cleared. The latch holding the last read value is not affected by a MCLR nor BOR Reset. After these Resets, the IOCIF flag will continue to be set if a mismatch is present. Note: 5.5.4 If a change on the I/O pin should occur when any PORTA operation is being executed, then the IOCIF interrupt flag may not get set. SLEW RATE CONTROL Two of the PORTA pins, RA0 and RA2, are equipped with high current driver circuitry. The SLRCONA register provides reduced slew rate control to mitigate possible EMI radiation from these pins. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 47 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 5-5: ANSELA: PORTA ANALOG SELECT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-1 U-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 — — — ANSA4 — ANSA2 ANSA1 ANSA0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 ANSA4: Analog Select Between Analog or Digital Function on Pin RA4 bit 1 = Analog input. Pin is assigned as analog input(1). 0 = Digital I/O. Pin is assigned to port or special function. x = Bit is unknown bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2-0 ANSA<2:0> Analog Select Between Analog or Digital Function on Pin RA<2:0> bits 1 = Analog input. Pin is assigned as analog input.(1) 0 = Digital I/O. Pin is assigned to port or special function. Note 1: Setting a pin to an analog input automatically disables the digital input circuitry, weak pull-ups, and interrupt-onchange if available. The corresponding TRIS bit must be set to Input mode in order to allow external control of the voltage on the pin. REGISTER 5-6: WPUA: WEAK PULL-UP PORTA REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 — — WPUA5 WPUA4 WPUA3 WPUA2 WPUA1 WPUA0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 WPUA<5:0>: Weak Pull-up Control bits(1,2,3) 1 = Pull-up enabled 0 = Pull-up disabled Note 1: 2: 3: x = Bit is unknown Global RAPU must be enabled for individual pull-ups to be enabled. The weak pull-up device is automatically disabled if the pin is in Output mode (TRISA = 0). The RA3 pull-up is enabled when configured as MCLR in the Configuration Word, otherwise it is disabled as an input and reads as ‘0’. DS40001709A-page 48 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 5-7: IOCAP: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE POSITIVE EDGE REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 — — IOCAP5 IOCAP4 IOCAP3 IOCAP2 IOCAP1 IOCAP0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 IOCAP<5:0>: Interrupt-on-Change Positive Edge Enable bits 1 = Interrupt-on-Change enabled on the pin for a positive going edge. Associated Status bit and interrupt flag will be set upon detecting an edge. 0 = Interrupt-on-Change disabled for the associated pin. REGISTER 5-8: IOCAN: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE NEGATIVE EDGE REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 — — IOCAN5 IOCAN4 IOCAN3 IOCAN2 IOCAN1 IOCAN0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 IOCAN<5:0>: Interrupt-on-Change Negative Edge Enable bits 1 = Interrupt-on-Change enabled on the pin for a negative going edge. Associated Status bit and interrupt flag will be set upon detecting an edge. 0 = Interrupt-on-Change disabled for the associated pin. REGISTER 5-9: IOCAF: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE FLAG REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0 — — IOCAF5 IOCAF4 IOCAF3 IOCAF2 IOCAF1 IOCAF0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared HS - Bit is set in hardware bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 IOCAF<5:0>: Interrupt-on-Change Flag bits 1 = An enabled change was detected on the associated pin. Set when IOCAPx = 1 and a rising edge was detected on RBx, or when IOCANx = 1 and a falling edge was detected on RAx. 0 = No change was detected, or the user cleared the detected change. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 49 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 5-2: Name SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTA Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 ADCON0 ADFM — ADCON1 — ANSELA — — — APFCON — — — Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page GO/DONE ADON 118 — — — ADPREF1 119 ANSA4 — ANSA2 ANSA1 ANSA0 48 T1GSEL — — — — 44 CHS<3:0> ADCS<2:0> CM1CON0 C1ON C1OUT C1OE C1POL C1ZLF C1SP C1HYS C1SYNC 139 CM2CON0 C2ON C2OUT C2OE C2POL C2ZLF C2SP C2HYS C2SYNC 139 CM1CON1 C1INTP C1INTN C1PCH<2:0> C1NCH<2:0> 140 CM2CON1 C2INTP C2INTN C2PCH<2:0> C2NCH<2:0> 140 DAC1CON0 DACEN DACFM DACOE — — — 130 IOCAF — — IOCAF5 IOCAF4 IOCAF3 IOCAF2 IOCAF1 IOCAF0 49 IOCAN — — IOCAN5 IOCAN4 IOCAN3 IOCAN2 IOCAN1 IOCAN0 49 IOCAP — — IOCAP5 IOCAP4 IOCAP3 IOCAP2 IOCAP1 IOCAP0 49 LATA2 LATA1 LATA0 LATA DACPSS1 DACPSS0 — — LATA5 LATA4 — RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA PORTA — — RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 46 SLRCONC — — SLRC5 SLRC4 — — — — 54 TRISA — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3(1) TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 46 OPTION_REG Legend: Note 1: 5.6 PS<2:0> 46 18 x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTA. TRISA3 always reads ‘1’. PORTC Registers 5.6.1 PORTC is a 6-bit wide port with five bidirectional and one input-only pin. The corresponding data direction register is TRISC (Register 5-2). Setting a TRISC bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTC pin an input (i.e., disable the output driver). Clearing a TRISC bit (= 0) will make the corresponding PORTC pin an output (i.e., enables output driver and puts the contents of the output latch on the selected pin). The exception is RA3, which is input-only and its TRIS bit will always read as ‘1’. Example 5-1 shows how to initialize PORTC. Reading the PORTC register (Register 5-2) reads the status of the pins, whereas writing to it will write to the PORT latch. All write operations are read-modify-write operations. Therefore, a write to a port implies that the port pins are read, this value is modified and then written to the PORT data latch. RC3 reads ‘0’ when MCLRE = 1. PORTC FUNCTIONS AND OUTPUT PRIORITIES Each PORTC pin is multiplexed with other functions. The pins, their combined functions and their output priorities are shown in Table 5-1. When multiple outputs are enabled, the actual pin control goes to the peripheral with the highest priority. Analog input functions, such as comparator inputs, are not shown in the priority lists. These inputs are active when the peripheral is enabled and the input multiplexer for the pin is selected. The Analog mode, set with the ANSELC register, disables the digital input buffer thereby preventing excessive input current when the analog input voltage is between logic states. Digital output functions may control the pin when it is in Analog mode with the priority shown in Table 5-1. The TRISC register controls the direction of the PORTC pins, even when they are being used as analog inputs. The user must ensure the bits in the TRISC register are maintained set when using them as analog inputs. I/O pins configured as analog input always read ‘0’. Note: The ANSEL register must be initialized to configure an analog channel as a digital input. Pins configured as analog inputs will read ‘0’ and cannot generate an interrupt. DS40001709A-page 50 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 5-3: PORTC OUTPUT PRIORITY Pin Name 5.7 Function Priority RC0 OPA1IN+ C2IN0+ RC0 RC1 OPA1INC1IN1C2IN1RC1 RC2 SLPCIN OPA1OUT C1IN2C2IN2RC2 RC3 C1IN3C2IN3RC3 RC4 COG1OUT1 C2OUT RC4 RC5 COG1OUT0 CCP1 RC5 PORTC Control Registers REGISTER 5-10: PORTC: PORTC REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R-x/x R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u — — RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 RC<5:0>: PORTC I/O Value bits(1) 1 = Port pin is > VIH 0 = Port pin is < VIL Note 1: Writes to PORTC are actually written to corresponding LATC register. Reads from PORTC register is return of actual I/O pin values. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 51 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 5-11: TRISC: PORTC TRI-STATE REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-1/1 R/W-1/1 R-1/1 R/W-1/1 R/W-1/1 R/W-1/1 — — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3(1) TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 TRISC<5:0>: PORTC Tri-State Control bits(1) 1 = PORTC pin configured as an input (tri-stated) 0 = PORTC pin configured as an output Note 1: TRISC3 always reads ‘1’. REGISTER 5-12: LATC: PORTC DATA LATCH REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-x/u R/W-x/u U-0 R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u — — LATC5 LATC4 — LATC2 LATC1 LATC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-4 LATC<5:4>: PORTC Output Latch Value bits(1) bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2-0 LATC<2:0>: PORTC Output Latch Value bits(1) Note 1: Writes to PORTC are actually written to corresponding LATC register. Reads from PORTC register is return of actual I/O pin values. DS40001709A-page 52 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 5.8 Additional Pin Functions 5.8.3 Every PORTC pin on the PIC16F753 has an interrupton-change option and a weak pull-up option. The next three sections describe these functions. 5.8.1 ANSELC REGISTER INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE Each PORTC pin is individually configurable as an interrupt-on-change pin. Control bit IOCC enables or disables the interrupt function for each pin. Refer to Register 5-7. The interrupt-on-change is disabled on a Power-on Reset. The ANSELC register (Register 5-5) is used to configure the Input mode of an I/O pin to analog. Setting the appropriate ANSELC bit high will cause all digital reads on the pin to be read as ‘0’ and allow analog functions on the pin to operate correctly. For enabled interrupt-on-change pins, the values are compared with the old value latched on the last read of PORTC. The ‘mismatch’ outputs of the last read are OR’d together to set the PORTC Change Interrupt Flag bit (IOCIF) in the INTCON register (Register 2-3). The state of the ANSELC bits has no effect on digital output functions. A pin with TRIS clear and ANSEL set will still operate as a digital output, but the Input mode will be analog. This can cause unexpected behavior when executing read-modify-write instructions on the affected port. This interrupt can wake the device from Sleep. The user, in the Interrupt Service Routine, clears the interrupt by: Note: 5.8.2 The ANSELC bits default to the Analog mode after Reset. To use any pins as digital general purpose or peripheral inputs, the corresponding ANSEL bits must be initialized to ‘0’ by user software. WEAK PULL-UPS Each of the PORTC pins, except RC3, has an individually configurable internal weak pull-up. Control bits WPUx enable or disable each pull-up. Refer to Register 5-6. Each weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are disabled on a Power-on Reset by the RAPU bit of the OPTION_REG register. A weak pull-up is automatically enabled for RC3 when configured as MCLR and disabled when RC3 is an I/O. There is no software control of the MCLR pull-up. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. a) Any read of PORTC AND Clear flag bit IOCIF. This will end the mismatch condition; OR b) Any write of PORTC AND Clear flag bit IOCIF will end the mismatch condition; A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit IOCIF. Reading PORTC will end the mismatch condition and allow flag bit IOCIF to be cleared. The latch holding the last read value is not affected by a MCLR nor BOR Reset. After these Resets, the IOCIF flag will continue to be set if a mismatch is present. Note: 5.8.4 If a change on the I/O pin should occur when any PORTC operation is being executed, then the IOCIF interrupt flag may not get set. SLEW RATE CONTROL Two of the PORTC pins, RC4 and RC5, are equipped with high current driver circuitry. The SLRCONC register provides reduced slew rate control to mitigate possible EMI radiation from these pins. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 53 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 5-13: SLRCONC: SLEW RATE CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-1/1 R/W-1/1 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — SLRC5 SLRC4 — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-4 SLRC<5:4>: Slew Rate Control Register bit 1 = Slew rate control enabled 0 = Slew rate control disabled bit 3-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ REGISTER 5-14: x = Bit is unknown ANSELC: PORTC ANALOG SELECT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 — — — — ANSC3 ANSC2 ANSC1 ANSC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 ANSC<3:0>: Analog Select Between Analog or Digital Function on Pin RC<3:0> bits 1 = Analog input. Pin is assigned as analog input.(1) 0 = Digital I/O. Pin is assigned to port or special function. Note 1: Setting a pin to an analog input automatically disables the digital input circuitry, weak pull-ups, and interrupt-onchange if available. The corresponding TRIS bit must be set to Input mode in order to allow external control of the voltage on the pin. DS40001709A-page 54 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 5-15: WPUC: WEAK PULL-UP PORTC REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 — — WPUC5 WPUC4 WPUC3 WPUC2 WPUC1 WPUC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 WPUC<5:0>: Weak Pull-up Control bits(1,2,3) 1 = Pull-up enabled 0 = Pull-up disabled Note 1: 2: 3: x = Bit is unknown Global RAPU must be enabled for individual pull-ups to be enabled. The weak pull-up device is automatically disabled if the pin is in Output mode (TRISC = 0). The RC3 pull-up is enabled when configured as MCLR in the Configuration Word, otherwise it is disabled as an input and reads as ‘0’. REGISTER 5-16: IOCCP: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE POSITIVE EDGE REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 — — IOCCP5 IOCCP4 IOCCP3 IOCCP2 IOCCP1 IOCCP0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 IOCCP<5:0>: Interrupt-on-Change Positive Edge Enable bits 1 = Interrupt-on-Change enabled on the pin for a positive going edge. Associated Status bit and interrupt flag will be set upon detecting an edge. 0 = Interrupt-on-Change disabled for the associated pin. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 55 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 5-17: IOCCN: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE NEGATIVE EDGE REGISTER U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 — — IOCCN5 IOCCN4 IOCCN3 IOCCN2 IOCCN1 IOCCN0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 IOCCN<5:0>: Interrupt-on-Change Negative Edge Enable bits 1 = Interrupt-on-Change enabled on the pin for a negative going edge. Associated Status bit and interrupt flag will be set upon detecting an edge. 0 = Interrupt-on-Change disabled for the associated pin. REGISTER 5-18: IOCCF: INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE FLAG REGISTER U-0 U-0 — — R/W/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0 IOCCF5 IOCCF4 IOCCF3 R/W/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0 R/W/HS-0/0 IOCCF2 IOCCF1 IOCCF0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared HS - Bit is set in hardware bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 IOCCF<5:0>: Interrupt-on-Change Flag bits 1 = An enabled change was detected on the associated pin. Set when IOCCPx = 1 and a rising edge was detected on RBx, or when IOCCNx = 1 and a falling edge was detected on RCx. 0 = No change was detected, or the user cleared the detected change. DS40001709A-page 56 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 5-4: Name SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTC Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 ADCON0 ADFM — ADCON1 — ANSELC — — — APFCON — — — Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page GO/DONE ADON 118 — — — ADPREF1 119 — ANSC3 ANSC2 ANSC1 ANSC0 48 T1GSEL — — — — 44 CHS<3:0> ADCS<2:0> CM1CON0 C1ON C1OUT C1OE C1POL C1ZLF C1SP C1HYS C1SYNC 139 CM2CON0 C2ON C2OUT C2OE C2POL C2ZLF C2SP C2HYS C2SYNC 139 CM1CON1 C1INTP C1INTN C1PCH<2:0> C1NCH<2:0> 140 CM2CON1 C2NTP C2INTN C2PCH<2:0> C2NCH<2:0> 140 DAC1CON0 DACEN DACFM DACOE — — — 130 IOCCF — — IOCCF5 IOCCF4 IOCCF3 IOCCF2 IOCCF1 IOCCF0 49 IOCCN — — IOCCN5 IOCCN4 IOCCN3 IOCCN2 IOCCN1 IOCCN0 49 IOCCP — — IOCCP5 IOCCP4 IOCCP3 IOCCP2 IOCCP1 IOCCP0 49 LATC2 LATC1 LATC0 46 LATC DACPSS1 DACPSS0 — — LATC5 LATC4 — RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA PORTC — — RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 46 SLRCONC — — SLRC5 SLRC4 — — — — 54 TRISC — — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3(1) TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 46 OPTION_REG Legend: Note 1: PS<2:0> 18 x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTA. TRISC3 always reads ‘1’. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 57 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 58 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 6.0 TIMER0 MODULE 6.1 Timer0 Operation The Timer0 module is an 8-bit timer/counter with the following features: When used as a timer, the Timer0 module can be used as either an 8-bit timer or an 8-bit counter. • • • • • 6.1.1 8-bit timer/counter register (TMR0) 8-bit prescaler (shared with Watchdog Timer) Programmable internal or external clock source Programmable external clock edge selection Interrupt on overflow 8-BIT TIMER MODE When used as a timer, the Timer0 module will increment every instruction cycle (without prescaler). Timer mode is selected by clearing the T0CS bit of the OPTION register to ‘0’. Figure 6-1 is a block diagram of the Timer0 module. When TMR0 is written, the increment is inhibited for two instruction cycles immediately following the write. Note: 6.1.2 The value written to the TMR0 register can be adjusted, in order to account for the two instruction cycle delay when TMR0 is written. 8-BIT COUNTER MODE When used as a counter, the Timer0 module will increment on every rising or falling edge of the T0CKI pin. The incrementing edge is determined by the T0SE bit of the OPTION_REG register. Counter mode is selected by setting the T0CS bit of the OPTION register to ‘1’. FIGURE 6-1: TIMER0 WITH SHARED PRESCALE BLOCK DIAGRAM FOSC/4 Data Bus 0 8 1 1 T0CKI pin T0CS T0SE Sync 2 TCY Shared Prescale TMR0 0 0 Set Flag bit T0IF on Overflow PSA 8-bit Prescaler 1 PSA PS<2:0> Watchdog Timer LFINTOSC 8 WDT Time-out 2 (Figure 4-1) 1 0 PSA PSA WDTE Note 1: 2: T0SE, T0CS, PSA, PS<2:0> are bits in Register 6-1. WDTE bit is in Register 19-1. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 59 PIC16F753/HV753 6.1.3 SOFTWARE PROGRAMMABLE PRESCALER A single software programmable prescaler is available for use with either Timer0 or the Watchdog Timer (WDT), but not both simultaneously. The prescaler assignment is controlled by the PSA bit of the OPTION register. To assign the prescaler to Timer0, the PSA bit must be cleared to a ‘0’. There are eight prescaler options for the Timer0 module ranging from 1:2 to 1:256. The prescale values are selectable via the PS<2:0> bits of the OPTION register. In order to have a 1:1 prescaler value for the Timer0 module, the prescaler must be assigned to the WDT module. The prescaler is not readable or writable. When assigned to the Timer0 module, all instructions writing to the TMR0 register will clear the prescaler. When the prescaler is assigned to WDT (PSA = 1), a CLRWDT instruction will clear the prescaler along with the WDT. 6.1.3.1 Switching Prescaler Between Timer0 and WDT Modules BANKSEL TMR0 CLRWDT CLRF TMR0 CHANGING PRESCALER (TIMER0 WDT) ; ;Clear WDT ;Clear TMR0 and ;prescaler BANKSEL OPTION_REG ; BSF OPTION_REG,PSA ;Select WDT CLRWDT ; ; MOVLW b’11111000’ ;Mask prescaler ANDWF OPTION_REG,W ;bits IORLW b’00000101’ ;Set WDT prescaler MOVWF OPTION_REG ;to 1:32 DS40001709A-page 60 EXAMPLE 6-2: CHANGING PRESCALER (WDT TIMER0) CLRWDT ;Clear WDT and ;prescaler BANKSEL OPTION_REG ; MOVLW b’11110000’ ;Mask TMR0 select and ANDWF OPTION_REG,W ;prescaler bits IORLW b’00000011’ ;Set prescale to 1:16 MOVWF OPTION_REG ; 6.1.4 TIMER0 INTERRUPT Timer0 will generate an interrupt when the TMR0 register overflows from FFh to 00h. The T0IF interrupt flag bit of the INTCON register is set every time the TMR0 register overflows, regardless of whether or not the Timer0 interrupt is enabled. The T0IF bit must be cleared in software. The Timer0 interrupt enable is the T0IE bit of the INTCON register. Note: As a result of having the prescaler assigned to either Timer0 or the WDT, it is possible to generate an unintended device Reset when switching prescaler values. When changing the prescaler assignment from Timer0 to the WDT module, the instruction sequence shown in Example 6-1 must be executed. EXAMPLE 6-1: When changing the prescaler assignment from the WDT to the Timer0 module, the following instruction sequence must be executed (see Example 6-2). 6.1.5 The Timer0 interrupt cannot wake the processor from Sleep since the timer is frozen during Sleep. USING TIMER0 WITH AN EXTERNAL CLOCK When Timer0 is in Counter mode, the synchronization of the T0CKI input and the Timer0 register is accomplished by sampling the prescaler output on the Q2 and Q4 cycles of the internal phase clocks. Therefore, the high and low periods of the external clock source must meet the timing requirements as shown in Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications”. Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 6.2 Register Definitions: Option and Timer0 Control REGISTER 6-1: OPTION_REG: OPTION REGISTER R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 PS<2:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 RAPU: PORTA Pull-up Enable bit 1 = PORTA pull-ups are disabled 0 = PORTA pull-ups are enabled by individual PORT latch values in WPU register bit 6 INTEDG: Interrupt Edge Select bit 1 = Interrupt on rising edge of INT pin 0 = Interrupt on falling edge of INT pin bit 5 T0CS: TMR0 Clock Source Select bit 1 = Transition on T0CKI pin 0 = Internal instruction cycle clock (FOSC/4) bit 4 T0SE: TMR0 Source Edge Select bit 1 = Increment on high-to-low transition on T0CKI pin 0 = Increment on low-to-high transition on T0CKI pin bit 3 PSA: Prescaler Assignment bit 1 = Prescaler is assigned to the WDT 0 = Prescaler is assigned to the Timer0 module bit 2-0 PS<2:0>: Prescaler Rate Select bits Bit Value 000 001 010 011 100 101 110 111 TABLE 6-1: Name TMR0 Rate 1:2 1:4 1:8 1 : 16 1 : 32 1 : 64 1 : 128 1 : 256 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 OPTION_REG Note 1: Bit 3 GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3(1) Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 T0IF INTF IOCIF TMR0<7:0> INTCON Legend: 1:1 1:2 1:4 1:8 1 : 16 1 : 32 1 : 64 1 : 128 SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER0 TMR0 TRISA WDT Rate Register on Page 59* PS<2:0> TRISA2 TRISA1 19 61 TRISA0 46 – = Unimplemented locations, read as ‘0’, u = unchanged, x = unknown. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer0 module. * Page provides register information. TRISA3 always reads ‘1’. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 61 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 62 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 7.0 TIMER1 MODULE WITH GATE CONTROL • • • • The Timer1 module is a 16-bit timer/counter with the following features: Figure 7-1 is a block diagram of the Timer1 module. • • • • • • • 16-bit timer/counter register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) Selectable internal or external clock sources 2-bit prescaler Synchronous or asynchronous operation Multiple Timer1 gate (count enable) sources Interrupt on overflow Wake-up on overflow (external clock, Asynchronous mode only) • Time base for the Capture/Compare function • Special Event Trigger (with CCP) • Selectable Gate Source Polarity FIGURE 7-1: Gate Toggle mode Gate Single-pulse mode Gate Value Status Gate Event Interrupt TIMER1 BLOCK DIAGRAM T1GSS<1:0> T1G 00 T0_overflow 01 C1OUT_sync 10 C2OUT_sync 11 T1GSPM 0 1 D D T1GVAL Q 0 Q1 Q T1GGO/DONE T1GPOL CK TMR1ON Q Interrupt R T1GTM set bit TMR1GIF det TMR1GE set flag bit TMR1IF T1_overflow 1 Single Pulse Acq. Control TMR1 TMR1H TMR1L TMR1ON EN (2) Q Synchronized Clock Input 0 D 1 T1CLK T1SYNC TMR1CS<1:0> (1) LFINTOSC T1CKI 11 10 Fosc Internal Clock 01 00 Fosc/4 Internal Clock Prescaler 1,2,4,8 2 T1CKPS<1:0> Synchronize(3) det Fosc/2 Internal Clock Sleep Input Note 1: ST Buffer is high speed type when using T 1CKI. 2: Timer1 register increments on rising edge. 3: Synchronize does not operate while in Sleep . 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 63 PIC16F753/HV753 7.1 Timer1 Operation 7.2 Clock Source Selection The Timer1 module is a 16-bit incrementing counter which is accessed through the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. Writes to TMR1H or TMR1L directly update the counter. The TMR1CS<1:0> bits of the T1CON register are used to select the clock source for Timer1. Table 7-2 displays the clock source selections. When used with an internal clock source, the module is a timer and increments on every instruction cycle. When used with an external clock source, the module can be used as either a timer or counter and increments on every selected edge of the external source. TABLE 7-2: Timer1 is enabled by configuring the TMR1ON and TMR1GE bits in the T1CON and T1GCON registers, respectively. Table 7-1 displays the Timer1 enable selections. TABLE 7-1: TMR1CS<1:0> CLOCK SOURCE SELECTIONS Clock Source 11 Temperature Sense Oscillator 10 External Clocking on T1CKI Pin 01 System Clock (FOSC) 00 Instruction Clock (FOSC/4) 7.2.1 INTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE When the internal clock source is selected, the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair will increment on multiples of FOSC or FOSC/4 as determined by the Timer1 prescaler. TIMER1 ENABLE SELECTIONS Timer1 Operation TMR1ON TMR1GE 0 0 Off 0 1 Off 1 0 Always On 1 1 Count Enabled 7.2.2 EXTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE When the external clock source is selected, the Timer1 module may work as a timer or a counter. When enabled to count, Timer1 is incremented on the rising edge of the external clock input T1CKI. Note: In Counter mode, a falling edge must be registered by the counter prior to the first incrementing rising edge (see Figure 7-2) after any one or more of the following conditions: • Timer1 enabled after POR Reset • Write to TMR1H or TMR1L • Timer1 is disabled • Timer1 is disabled (TMR1ON = 0) when T1CKI is high then Timer1 is enabled (TMR1ON=1) when T1CKI is low. 7.2.3 WDT OSCILLATOR When the Watchdog is selected, Timer 1 will use the LFINTOSC that is used to operate the Watchdog Timer. This is the same oscillator as the LFINTOSC used as the system clock. Selecting this option will enable the oscillator even when the LFINTOSC or the Watchdog are not in use. This oscillator will continue to operate when in Sleep mode. DS40001709A-page 64 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 7.3 Timer1 Prescaler 7.5 Timer1 Gate Timer1 has four prescaler options allowing one, two, four or eight divisions of the clock input. The T1CKPS bits of the T1CON register control the prescale counter. The prescale counter is not directly readable or writable; however, the prescaler counter is cleared upon a write to TMR1H or TMR1L. Timer1 can be configured to count freely or the count can be enabled and disabled using Timer1 gate circuitry. This is also referred to as Timer1 gate count enable. 7.4 7.5.1 Timer1 Operation in Asynchronous Counter Mode If control bit T1SYNC of the T1CON register is set, the external clock input is not synchronized. The timer increments asynchronously to the internal phase clocks. If external clock source is selected then the timer will continue to run during Sleep and can generate an interrupt on overflow, which will wake-up the processor. However, special precautions in software are needed to read/write the timer (see Section 7.4.1 “Reading and Writing Timer1 in Asynchronous Counter Mode”). Note: 7.4.1 When switching from synchronous to asynchronous operation, it is possible to skip an increment. When switching from asynchronous to synchronous operation, it is possible to produce an additional increment. READING AND WRITING TIMER1 IN ASYNCHRONOUS COUNTER MODE Reading TMR1H or TMR1L while the timer is running from an external asynchronous clock will ensure a valid read (taken care of in hardware). However, the user should keep in mind that reading the 16-bit timer in two 8-bit values itself, poses certain problems, since the timer may overflow between the reads. For writes, it is recommended that the user simply stop the timer and write the desired values. A write contention may occur by writing to the timer registers, while the register is incrementing. This may produce an unpredictable value in the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Timer1 gate can also be driven by multiple selectable sources. TIMER1 GATE COUNT ENABLE The Timer1 gate is enabled by setting the TMR1GE bit of the T1GCON register. The polarity of the Timer1 gate is configured using the T1GPOL bit of the T1GCON register. When Timer1 Gate (T1G) input is active, Timer1 will increment on the rising edge of the Timer1 clock source. When Timer1 gate input is inactive, no incrementing will occur and Timer1 will hold the current count. See Figure 7-3 for timing details. TABLE 7-3: TIMER1 GATE ENABLE SELECTIONS T1CLK T1GPOL T1G 0 0 Counts 0 1 Holds Count 1 0 Holds Count 1 1 Counts 7.5.2 Timer1 Operation TIMER1 GATE SOURCE SELECTION The Timer1 gate source can be selected from one of four different sources. Source selection is controlled by the T1GSS bits of the T1GCON register. The polarity for each available source is also selectable. Polarity selection is controlled by the T1GPOL bit of the T1GCON register. TABLE 7-4: T1GSS TIMER1 GATE SOURCES Timer1 Gate Source 11 SYNCC2OUT 10 SYNCC1OUT 01 Overflow of Timer0 (TMR0 increments from FFh to 00h) 00 Timer1 Gate Pin Preliminary DS40001709A-page 65 PIC16F753/HV753 7.5.2.1 T1G Pin Gate Operation 7.5.5 The T1G pin is one source for Timer1 gate control. It can be used to supply an external source to the Timer1 gate circuitry. 7.5.2.2 Timer0 Overflow Gate Operation When Timer0 increments from FFh to 00h, a low-tohigh pulse will automatically be generated and internally supplied to the Timer1 gate circuitry. 7.5.2.3 C1OUT/C2OUT Gate Operation The outputs from the Comparator C1 and C2 modules can be used as gate sources for the Timer1 module. 7.5.3 TIMER1 GATE TOGGLE MODE When Timer1 Gate Toggle mode is enabled, it is possible to measure the full-cycle length of a Timer1 gate signal, as opposed to the duration of a single-level pulse. TIMER1 GATE VALUE STATUS When Timer1 gate value status is utilized, it is possible to read the most current level of the gate control value. The value is stored in the T1GVAL bit in the T1GCON register. The T1GVAL bit is valid even when the Timer1 gate is not enabled (TMR1GE bit is cleared). 7.5.6 TIMER1 GATE EVENT INTERRUPT When Timer1 gate event interrupt is enabled, it is possible to generate an interrupt upon the completion of a gate event. When the falling edge of T1GVAL occurs, the TMR1GIF flag bit in the PIR1 register will be set. If the TMR1GIE bit in the PIE1 register is set, then an interrupt will be recognized. The TMR1GIF flag bit operates even when the Timer1 gate is not enabled (TMR1GE bit is cleared). The Timer1 gate source is routed through a flip-flop that changes state on every incrementing edge of the signal. See Figure 7-4 for timing details. Timer1 Gate Toggle mode is enabled by setting the T1GTM bit of the T1GCON register. When the T1GTM bit is cleared, the flip-flop is cleared and held clear. This is necessary in order to control which edge is measured. Note: 7.5.4 Enabling Toggle mode at the same time as changing the gate polarity may result in indeterminate operation. TIMER1 GATE SINGLE-PULSE MODE When Timer1 Gate Single-Pulse mode is enabled, it is possible to capture a single-pulse gate event. Timer1 Gate Single-Pulse mode is first enabled by setting the T1GSPM bit in the T1GCON register. Next, the T1GGO/DONE bit in the T1GCON register must be set. The Timer1 will be fully enabled on the next incrementing edge. On the next trailing edge of the pulse, the T1GGO/DONE bit will automatically be cleared. No other gate events will be allowed to increment Timer1 until the T1GGO/DONE bit is once again set in software. Clearing the T1GSPM bit of the T1GCON register will also clear the T1GGO/DONE bit. See Figure 7-5 for timing details. Enabling the Toggle mode and the Single-Pulse mode simultaneously will permit both sections to work together. This allows the cycle times on the Timer1 gate source to be measured. See Figure 7-6 for timing details. DS40001709A-page 66 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 7.6 Timer1 Interrupt 7.8 The Timer1 register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) increments to FFFFh and rolls over to 0000h. When Timer1 rolls over, the Timer1 interrupt flag bit of the PIR1 register is set. To enable the interrupt on rollover, you must set these bits: • • • • TMR1ON bit of the T1CON register TMR1IE bit of the PIE1 register PEIE bit of the INTCON register GIE bit of the INTCON register The interrupt is cleared by clearing the TMR1IF bit in the Interrupt Service Routine. Note: 7.7 The TMR1H:TMR1L register pair and the TMR1IF bit should be cleared before enabling interrupts. Timer1 Operation During Sleep Timer1 can only operate during Sleep when set up in Asynchronous Counter mode or with the internal watchdog clock source. In this mode, the clock source can be used to increment the counter. To set up the timer to wake the device: • • • • • TMR1ON bit of the T1CON register must be set TMR1IE bit of the PIE1 register must be set PEIE bit of the INTCON register must be set T1SYNC bit of the T1CON register must be set TMR1CS bits of the T1CON register must be configured • TMR1GE bit of the T1GCON register must be configured CCP Capture/Compare Time Base The CCP module uses the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair as the time base when operating in Capture or Compare mode. In Capture mode, the value in the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair is copied into the CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair on a configured event. In Compare mode, an event is triggered when the value CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair matches the value in the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. This event can be a Special Event Trigger. For more information, see Section 10.0 “Capture/ Compare/PWM Modules”. 7.9 CCP Special Event Trigger When the CCP is configured to trigger a special event, the trigger will clear the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. This special event does not cause a Timer1 interrupt. The CCP module may still be configured to generate a CCP interrupt. In this mode of operation, the CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair becomes the period register for Timer1. Timer1 should be synchronized to the FOSC/4 to utilize the Special Event Trigger. Asynchronous operation of Timer1 can cause a Special Event Trigger to be missed. In the event that a write to TMR1H or TMR1L coincides with a Special Event Trigger from the CCP, the write will take precedence. For more information, see Section 12.2.5 “Special Event Trigger”. The device will wake-up on an overflow and execute the next instructions. If the GIE bit of the INTCON register is set, the device will call the Interrupt Service Routine (0004h). FIGURE 7-2: TIMER1 INCREMENTING EDGE T1CKI T1CKI TMR1 enabled Note 1: 2: Arrows indicate counter increments. In Counter mode, a falling edge must be registered by the counter prior to the first incrementing rising edge of the clock. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 67 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 7-3: TIMER1 GATE COUNT ENABLE MODE TMR1GE T1GPOL T1G_IN T1CKI T1GVAL TIMER1 N FIGURE 7-4: N+1 N+2 N+3 N+4 TIMER1 GATE TOGGLE MODE TMR1GE T1GPOL T1GTM T1G_IN T1CKI T1GVAL TIMER1 N DS40001709A-page 68 N+1 N+2 N+3 N+4 Preliminary N+5 N+6 N+7 N+8 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 7-5: TIMER1 GATE SINGLE-PULSE MODE TMR1GE T1GPOL T1GSPM T1GGO/ Cleared by hardware on falling edge of T1GVAL Set by software DONE Counting enabled on rising edge of T1G T1G_IN T1CKI T1GVAL TIMER1 TMR1GIF N N+1 Set by hardware on falling edge of T1GVAL Cleared by software 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. N+2 Preliminary Cleared by software DS40001709A-page 69 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 7-6: TIMER1 GATE SINGLE-PULSE AND TOGGLE COMBINED MODE TMR1GE T1GPOL T1GSPM T1GTM T1GGO/ Cleared by hardware on falling edge of T1GVAL Set by software DONE Counting enabled on rising edge of T1G T1G_IN T1CKI T1GVAL TIMER1 TMR1GIF DS40001709A-page 70 N Cleared by software N+1 N+2 N+3 Set by hardware on falling edge of T1GVAL Preliminary N+4 Cleared by software 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 7.10 Register Definitions: Timer1 Control REGISTER 7-1: R/W-0 T1CON: TIMER1 CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 TMR1CS<1:0> R/W-0 R/W-0 T1CKPS<1:0> R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC — TMR1ON bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 TMR1CS<1:0>: Timer1 Clock Source Select bits 11 = Watchdog timer oscillator 10 = External clock from T1CKI pin (on the rising edge) 01 = Timer1 clock source is system clock (FOSC) 00 = Timer1 clock source is instruction clock (FOSC/4) bit 5-4 T1CKPS<1:0>: Timer1 Input Clock Prescale Select bits 11 = 1:8 Prescale value 10 = 1:4 Prescale value 01 = 1:2 Prescale value 00 = 1:1 Prescale value bit 3 T1OSCEN: This bit is ignored. bit 2 T1SYNC: Timer1 External Clock Input Synchronization Control bit TMR1CS<1:0> = 1X 1 = Do not synchronize external clock input 0 = Synchronize external clock input with system clock (FOSC) x = Bit is unknown TMR1CS<1:0> = 0X This bit is ignored. Timer1 uses the internal clock when TMR1CS<1:0> = 1X. bit 1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 TMR1ON: Timer1 On bit 1 = Enables Timer1 0 = Stops Timer1 Clears Timer1 gate flip-flop 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 71 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 7-2: T1GCON: TIMER1 GATE CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R-x R/W-0 TMR1GE T1GPOL T1GTM T1GSPM T1GGO/DONE T1GVAL R/W-0 T1GSS<1:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 TMR1GE: Timer1 Gate Enable bit If TMR1ON = 0: This bit is ignored If TMR1ON = 1: 1 = Timer1 counting is controlled by the Timer1 gate function 0 = Timer1 counts regardless of Timer1 gate function bit 6 T1GPOL: Timer1 Gate Polarity bit 1 = Timer1 gate is active-high (Timer1 counts when gate is high) 0 = Timer1 gate is active-low (Timer1 counts when gate is low) bit 5 T1GTM: Timer1 Gate Toggle mode bit 1 = Timer1 Gate Toggle mode is enabled. 0 = Timer1 Gate Toggle mode is disabled and toggle flip-flop is cleared Timer1 gate flip-flop toggles on every rising edge. bit 4 T1GSPM: Timer1 Gate Single-Pulse mode bit 1 = Timer1 Gate Single-Pulse mode is enabled and is controlling Timer1 gate 0 = Timer1 Gate Single-Pulse mode is disabled bit 3 T1GGO/DONE: Timer1 Gate Single-Pulse Acquisition Status bit 1 = Timer1 gate single-pulse acquisition is ready, waiting for an edge 0 = Timer1 gate single-pulse acquisition has completed or has not been started This bit is automatically cleared when T1GSPM is cleared. bit 2 T1GVAL: Timer1 Gate Current State bit Indicates the current state of the Timer1 gate that could be provided to TMR1H:TMR1L. Unaffected by Timer1 Gate Enable (TMR1GE). bit 1-0 T1GSS<1:0>: Timer1 Gate Source Select bits 11 = SYNCC2OUT 10 = SYNCC1OUT 01 = Timer0 overflow output 00 = Timer1 gate pin DS40001709A-page 72 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 7-5: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER1 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page ANSELA — — — ANSA4 — ANSA2 ANSA1 ANSA0 48 APFCON — — — T1GSEL — — — — 44 CCP1CON — — GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF 19 PIE1 TMR1GIE ADIE — — HLTMR2IE HLTMR1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 20 PIR1 TMR1GIF ADIF — — HLTMR2IF HLTMR1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF 22 — — RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 46 Name INTCON PORTA DC1B<1:0> CCP1M<3:0> TMR1H TMR1H<7:0> TMR1L — T1CON TMR1CS<1:0> Legend: * 63* TMR1L<7:0> TRISA T1GCON 87 TMR1GE — T1GPOL TRISA5 TRISA4 T1CKPS<1:0> T1GTM T1GSPM 63* TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 46 T1OSCEN T1SYNC — TMR1ON 71 T1GGO/ DONE T1GVAL T1GSS<1:0> 72 x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer1 module. Page provides register information. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 73 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 74 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 8.0 TIMER2 MODULE The TMR2 and PR2 registers are both fully readable and writable. On any Reset, the TMR2 register is set to 00h and the PR2 register is set to FFh. The Timer2 module is an 8-bit timer with the following features: Timer2 is turned on by setting the TMR2ON bit in the T2CON register to a ‘1’. Timer2 is turned off by clearing the TMR2ON bit to a ‘0’. • • • • 8-bit timer register (TMR2) 8-bit period register (PR2) Interrupt on TMR2 match with PR2 Software programmable prescaler (1:1, 1:4, 1:16, 1:64) • Software programmable postscaler (1:1 to 1:16) The Timer2 prescaler is controlled by the T2CKPS bits in the T2CON register. The Timer2 postscaler is controlled by the T2OUTPS bits in the T2CON register. The prescaler and postscaler counters are cleared when: See Figure 8-1 for a block diagram of Timer2. 8.1 • A write to TMR2 occurs. • A write to T2CON occurs. • Any device Reset occurs (Power-on Reset, MCLR Reset, Watchdog Timer Reset, or Brown-out Reset). Timer2 Operation The clock input to the Timer2 module is the system instruction clock (FOSC/4). The clock is fed into the Timer2 prescaler, which has prescale options of 1:1, 1:4 or 1:16. The output of the prescaler is then used to increment the TMR2 register. Note: TMR2 is not cleared when T2CON is written. The values of TMR2 and PR2 are constantly compared to determine when they match. TMR2 will increment from 00h until it matches the value in PR2. When a match occurs, two things happen: • TMR2 is reset to 00h on the next increment cycle. • The Timer2 postscaler is incremented The match output of the Timer2/PR2 comparator is then fed into the Timer2 postscaler. The postscaler has postscale options of 1:1 to 1:16 inclusive. The output of the Timer2 postscaler is used to set the TMR2IF interrupt flag bit in the PIR1 register. FIGURE 8-1: Fosc/4 TIMER2 BLOCK DIAGRAM Prescaler 1:1, 1:4, 1:16, 1:64 T2_match TMR2 R To Peripherals 2 T2CKPS<1:0> Comparator Postscaler 1:1 to 1:16 set bit TMR2IF 4 PR2 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary T2OUTPS<3:0> DS40001709A-page 75 PIC16F753/HV753 8.2 Register Definitions: Timer2 Control REGISTER 8-1: T2CON: TIMER2 CONTROL REGISTER U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 T2OUTPS<3:0> R/W-0 R/W-0 TMR2ON R/W-0 T2CKPS<1:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-3 T2OUTPS<3:0>: Timer2 Output Postscaler Select bits 0000 = 1:1 Postscaler 0001 = 1:2 Postscaler 0010 = 1:3 Postscaler 0011 = 1:4 Postscaler 0100 = 1:5 Postscaler 0101 = 1:6 Postscaler 0110 = 1:7 Postscaler 0111 = 1:8 Postscaler 1000 = 1:9 Postscaler 1001 = 1:10 Postscaler 1010 = 1:11 Postscaler 1011 = 1:12 Postscaler 1100 = 1:13 Postscaler 1101 = 1:14 Postscaler 1110 = 1:15 Postscaler 1111 = 1:16 Postscaler bit 2 TMR2ON: Timer2 On bit 1 = Timer2 is on 0 = Timer2 is off bit 1-0 T2CKPS<1:0>: Timer2 Clock Prescale Select bits 00 = Prescaler is 1 01 = Prescaler is 4 10 = Prescaler is 16 11 = Prescaler is 64 TABLE 8-1: Name INTCON SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER2 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 GIE PEIE T0IE INTE PIE1 TMR1GIE ADIE — — PIR1 TMR1GIF ADIF — — PR2 Legend: * Bit 3 Bit 2 IOCIE T0IF Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page INTF IOCIF 19 HLTMR2IE HLTMR1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 20 HLTMR2IF TMR2IF TMR1IF HLTMR1IF PR2<7:0> TMR2 T2CON x = Bit is unknown TMR2<7:0> — T2OUTPS<3:0> 22 75* 75* TMR2ON T2CKPS<1:0> 76 x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for Timer2 module. Page provides register information. DS40001709A-page 76 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 9.0 HARDWARE LIMIT TIMER (HLT) MODULE The HLT module incorporates the following features: • 8-bit Read-Write Timer Register (HLTMRx) • 8-bit Read-Write Period register (HLTPRx) • Software programmable prescaler: - 1:1 - 1:4 - 1:16 - 1:64 • Software programmable postscaler - 1:1 to 1:16, inclusive • Interrupt on HLTMRx match with HLTPRx • Eight selectable timer Reset inputs (two reserved) • Reset on rising and falling event The Hardware Limit Timer (HLT) module is a version of the Timer2-type modules. In addition to all the Timer2type features, the HLT can be reset on rising and falling events from selected peripheral outputs. The HLT primary purpose is to act as a timed hardware limit to be used in conjunction with asynchronous analog feedback applications. The external Reset source synchronizes the HLTMRx to an analog application. In normal operation, the external Reset source from the analog application should occur before the HLTMRx matches the HLTPRx. This resets HLTMRx for the next period and prevents the HLTimerx Output from going active. Refer to Figure 9-1 for a block diagram of the HLT. When the external Reset source fails to generate a signal within the expected time, (allowing the HLTMRx to match the HLTPRx), then the HLTimerx Output becomes active. FIGURE 9-1: HLTMRx BLOCK DIAGRAM CCP1 out 000 C1OUT 001 C2OUT 010 COG1FLT 011 COG1OUT0 100 COG1OUT1 101 ‘0’ 110 ‘0’ 111 Fosc/4 HxON HxRES HxREREN Detect 1 0 0 HxFEREN 1 Detect HLT Output To COG module HxFES Prescaler 1:1, 1:4, 1:16, 1:64 HxCKPS<1:0> HLTMRx Comparator HLTPRx 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary Postscaler 1:1 to 1:16 HLTMRxIF HxOUTPS<3:0> DS40001709A-page 77 PIC16F753/HV753 9.1 HLT Operation 9.3 The clock input to the HLT module is the system instruction clock (FOSC/4). HLTMRx increments on each rising clock edge. A 4-bit counter/prescaler on the clock input provides the following prescale options: • • • • Direct input Divide-by-4 Divide-by-16 Divide-by-64 The prescale options are selected by the prescaler control bits, HxCKPS<1:0> of the HLTxCON0 register. The value of HLTMRx is compared to that of the Period register, HLTPRx, on each clock cycle. When the two values match,then the comparator generates a match signal as the HLTimerx output. This signal also resets the value of HLTMRx to 00h on the next clock rising edge and drives the output counter/postscaler (see Section 9.2 “HLT Interrupt”). The HLTMRx and HLTPRx registers are both directly readable and writable. The HLTMRx register is cleared on any device Reset, whereas the HLTPRx register initializes to FFh. Both the prescaler and postscaler counters are cleared on any of the following events: • • • • • • • • • A write to the HLTMRx register A write to the HLTxCON0 register Power-on Reset (POR) Brown-out Reset (BOR) MCLR Reset Watchdog Timer (WDT) Reset Stack Overflow Reset Stack Underflow Reset RESET Instruction Note: 9.2 Resets driven from the selected peripheral output prevents the HLTMRx from matching the HLTPRx register and generating an output. In this manner, the HLT can be used as a hardware time limit to other peripherals. In this device, the primary purpose of the HLT is to limit the COG PWM duty cycle. Normally, the COG operation uses analog feedback to determine the PWM duty cycle. The same feedback signal is used as an HLT Reset input. The HLTPRx register is set to occur at the maximum allowed duty cycle. If the analog feedback to the COG exceeds the maximum time, then an HLTMRx-to-HLTPRx match will occur and generate the output needed to limit the COG drive output. The HLTMRx can be reset by one of several selectable peripheral sources. Reset inputs include: • • • • • • CCP1 output Comparator 1 output Comparator 2 output COGxFLT pin COG1OUT0 COG1OUT1 The external Reset input is selected with the HxERS<2:0> bits of the HLTxCON1 register. High and low Reset enables are selected with the HxREREN and HxFEREN bits, respectively. Setting the HxRES and HxFES bits makes the respective rising and falling Reset events edge sensitive. Reset inputs that are not edge sensitive are level sensitive. HLTMRx Resets are synchronous with the HLT clock. In other words, HLTMRx is cleared on the rising edge of the HLT clock after the enabled Reset event occurs. HLTMRx is not cleared when HLTxCON0 is written. If an enabled external Reset occurs at the same time a write occurs to the TMR4A register, the write to the timer takes precedence and pending Resets are cleared. 9.4 HLT Interrupt The HLT can also generate an optional device interrupt. The HLTMRx output signal (HLTMRx-to-HLTPRx match) provides the input for the 4-bit counter/postscaler. The overflow output of the postscaler sets the HLTMRxIF bit of the PIR1 register. The interrupt is enabled by setting the HLTMRx Match Interrupt Enable bit, HLTMRxIE of the PIE1 register. A range of 16 postscale options (from 1:1 through 1:16 inclusive) can be selected with the postscaler control bits, HxOUTPS<3:0>, of the HLTxCON0 register. DS40001709A-page 78 Peripheral Resets HLTimerx Output The unscaled output of HLTMRx is available only to the COG module, where it is used as a selectable limit to the maximum COG period. 9.5 HLT Operation During Sleep The HLT cannot be operated while the processor is in Sleep mode. The contents of the HLTMRx register will remain unchanged while the processor is in Sleep mode. Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 9.6 Register Definitions: HLT Control Registers REGISTER 9-1: U-0 HLTxCON0: HLTx CONTROL REGISTER 0 R/W-0/0 — R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 HxOUTPS<3:0> R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 HxON bit 7 R/W-0/0 HxCKPS<1:0> bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-3 HxOUTPS<3:0>: Hardware Limit Timerx Output Postscaler Select bits 0000 = 1:1 Postscaler 0001 = 1:2 Postscaler 0010 = 1:3 Postscaler 0011 = 1:4 Postscaler 0100 = 1:5 Postscaler 0101 = 1:6 Postscaler 0110 = 1:7 Postscaler 0111 = 1:8 Postscaler 1000 = 1:9 Postscaler 1001 = 1:10 Postscaler 1010 = 1:11 Postscaler 1011 = 1:12 Postscaler 1100 = 1:13 Postscaler 1101 = 1:14 Postscaler 1110 = 1:15 Postscaler 1111 = 1:16 Postscaler bit 2 HxON: Hardware Limit Timerx On bit 1 = Timer is on 0 = Timer is off bit 1-0 HxCKPS<1:0>: Hardware Limit Timer x Clock Prescale Select bits 00 = Prescaler is 1 01 = Prescaler is 4 10 = Prescaler is 16 11 = Prescaler is 64 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 79 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 9-2: HLTxCON1: HLTx CONTROL REGISTER 1 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 U-0 HxFES HxRES — R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 HxERS<2:0> R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 HxFEREN HxREREN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 HxFES: Hardware Limit Timerx Falling Edge Sensitivity bit 1 = Edge sensitive 0 = Level sensitive bit 6 HxRES: Hardware Limit Timerx Rising Edge Sensitivity bit 1 = Edge sensitive 0 = Level sensitive bit 5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4-2 HxERS<2:0>: Hardware Limit Timerx External Reset Source Select bits 000 = CCP1 Out 001 = C1OUT 010 = C2OUT 011 = COG1FLT 100 = COG1OUT0 101 = COG1OUT1 110 = Reserved - ‘0’ input 111 = Reserved - ‘0’ input bit 1 HxFEREN: Hardware Limit Timerx Falling Event Reset Enable bit 1 = HLTMRx will reset on the first clock after a falling event of selected Reset source 0 = Falling events of selected source have no effect bit 0 HxREREN: Hardware Limit Timerx Rising Event Reset Enable bit 1 = HLTMRx will reset on the first clock after a rising event of selected Reset source 0 = Rising events of selected source have no effect TABLE 9-1: Name CCP1CON SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH HLT Bit 7 Bit 6 — — Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 DC1B<1:0> CM1CON0 C1ON C1OUT CM1CON1 C1INTP C1INTN CM2CON0 C2ON C2OUT CM2CON1 C2INTP C2INTN C1OE Bit 2 Bit 0 CCP1M<3:0> C1POL C1ZLF C1SP C2POL C1HYS C2ZLF C2SP C1SYNC C2HYS C2SYNC GIE PEIE T0IE INTE INTF IOCIF 19 TMR1GIE ADIE — — HLTMR2IE HLTMR1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 20 PIR1 TMR1GIF ADIF — — HLTMR2IF HLTMR1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF HLTMRx Holding Register for the 8-bit Hardware Limit TimerX Count HLTPRx HLTxCON0 HLTxCON1 Legend: * T0IF 139 140 PIE1 INTCON IOCIE 139 140 C2NCH<2:0> C2PCH<2:0> Register on Page 87 C1NCH<2:0> C1PCH<2:0> C2OE Bit 1 HLTMRx Module Period Register — HxFES HxOUTPS<3:0> HxRES — 77* HxON HxERS<2:0> 22 77* HxCKPS<1:0> HxFEREN HxREREN 79 80 — = unimplemented location, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells do not affect the HLT module operation. Page provides register information. DS40001709A-page 80 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 10.0 CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM MODULES 10.1.2 The Capture/Compare/PWM module is a peripheral which allows the user to time and control different events, and to generate Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) signals. In Capture mode, the peripheral allows the timing of the duration of an event. The Compare mode allows the user to trigger an external event when a predetermined amount of time has expired. The PWM mode can generate Pulse-Width Modulated signals of varying frequency and duty cycle. 10.1 Capture Mode Capture mode makes use of the 16-bit Timer1 resource. When an event occurs on the CCP1 pin, the 16-bit CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair captures and stores the 16-bit value of the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair, respectively. An event is defined as one of the following and is configured by the CCP1M<3:0> bits of the CCP1CON register: • • • • Every falling edge Every rising edge Every 4th rising edge Every 16th rising edge Figure 10-1 shows a simplified diagram of the Capture operation. 10.1.1 CCP1 PIN CONFIGURATION In Capture mode, the CCP1 pin should be configured as an input by setting the associated TRIS control bit. Note: If the CCP1 pin is configured as an output, a write to the port can cause a capture condition. FIGURE 10-1: Prescaler 1, 4, 16 Timer1 must be running in Timer mode or Synchronized Counter mode for the CCP1 module to use the capture feature. In Asynchronous Counter mode, the capture operation may not work. See Section 7.0 “Timer1 Module with Gate Control” for more information on configuring Timer1. 10.1.3 CAPTURE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM Note: CCPR1H and Edge Detect Clocking Timer1 from the system clock (FOSC) should not be used in Capture mode. In order for Capture mode to recognize the trigger event on the CCP1 pin, Timer1 must be clocked from the instruction clock (FOSC/4) or from an external clock source. CCP1 PRESCALER There are four prescaler settings specified by the CCP1M<3:0> bits of the CCP1CON register. Whenever the CCP1 module is turned off, or the CCP1 module is not in Capture mode, the prescaler counter is cleared. Any Reset will clear the prescaler counter. Switching from one capture prescaler to another does not clear the prescaler and may generate a false interrupt. To avoid this unexpected operation, turn the module off by clearing the CCP1CON register before changing the prescaler. Example 10-1 demonstrates the code to perform this function. EXAMPLE 10-1: CHANGING BETWEEN CAPTURE PRESCALERS BANKSEL CCP1CON CLRF MOVLW MOVWF Set Flag bit CCP1IF (PIR2 register) CCP1 pin SOFTWARE INTERRUPT MODE When the Capture mode is changed, a false capture interrupt may be generated. The user should keep the CCP1IE interrupt enable bit of the PIE2 register clear to avoid false interrupts. Additionally, the user should clear the CCP1IF interrupt flag bit of the PIR2 register following any change in Operating mode. 10.1.4 When a capture is made, the Interrupt Request Flag bit CCP1IF of the PIR2 register is set. The interrupt flag must be cleared in software. If another capture occurs before the value in the CCPR1H, CCPR1L register pair is read, the old captured value is overwritten by the new captured value. TIMER1 MODE RESOURCE ;Set Bank bits to point ;to CCP1CON CCP1CON ;Turn CCP1 module off NEW_CAPT_PS ;Load the W reg with ;the new prescaler ;move value and CCP1 ON CCP1CON ;Load CCP1CON with this ;value CCPR1L Capture Enable TMR1H TMR1L CCP1M<3:0> System Clock (FOSC) 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 81 PIC16F753/HV753 10.1.5 CAPTURE DURING SLEEP Capture mode depends upon the Timer1 module for proper operation. If the Timer1 clock input source is a clock that is not disabled during Sleep, Timer1 will continue to operate and Capture mode will operate during Sleep to wake the device. The T1CKI is an example of a clock source that will operate during Sleep. When the input source to Timer1 is disabled during Sleep, such as the HFINTOSC, Timer1 will not increment during Sleep. When the device wakes from Sleep, Timer1 will continue from its previous state. TABLE 10-1: Name CCP1CON SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH CAPTURE Bit 7 Bit 6 — — Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 DC1B<1:0> CCPR1L<7:0> CCPR1H CCPR1H<7:0> PIE1 Bit 1 Bit 0 CCP1M<3:0> CCPR1L INTCON Bit 2 Register on Page 87 81 81 GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF 19 TMR1GIE ADIE — — HLTMR2IE HLTMR1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 20 PIE2 — — C2IE C1IE — COG1IE — CCP1IE 21 PIR1 TMR1GIF ADIF — — HLTMR2IF HLTMR1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF 22 PIR2 — — C2IF C1IF — COG1IF — CCP1IF 23 T1CON TMR1CS<1:0> T1OSCEN T1SYNC — TMR1ON 71 T1GGO/ DONE T1GVAL T1GCON TMR1GE T1GPOL T1CKPS<1:0> T1GTM TMR1H T1GSS<1:0> TMR1H<7:0> TMR1L TRISA T1GSPM 63* TMR1L<7:0> — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3(1) 72 63* TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 46 Legend: — = Unimplemented location, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by Capture mode. * Page provides register information. Note 1: TRISA3 always reads ‘1’. DS40001709A-page 82 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 10.2 Compare Mode 10.2.2 Compare mode makes use of the 16-bit Timer1 resource. The 16-bit value of the CCPR1H:CCPR1L register pair is constantly compared against the 16-bit value of the TMR1H:TMR1L register pair. When a match occurs, one of the following events can occur: • • • • • Toggle the CCP1 output Set the CCP1 output Clear the CCP1 output Generate a Special Event Trigger Generate a Software Interrupt TIMER1 MODE RESOURCE In Compare mode, Timer1 must be running in either Timer mode or Synchronized Counter mode. The compare operation may not work in Asynchronous Counter mode. See Section 7.0 “Timer1 Module with Gate Control” for more information on configuring Timer1. Note: The action on the pin is based on the value of the CCP1M<3:0> control bits of the CCP1CON register. At the same time, the interrupt flag CCP1IF bit is set. Clocking Timer1 from the system clock (FOSC) should not be used in Compare mode. In order for Compare mode to recognize the trigger event on the CCP1 pin, TImer1 must be clocked from the instruction clock (FOSC/4) or from an external clock source. All Compare modes can generate an interrupt. 10.2.3 Figure 10-2 shows a simplified diagram of the Compare operation. When Generate Software Interrupt mode is chosen (CCP1M<3:0> = 1010), the CCP1 module does not assert control of the CCP1 pin (see the CCP1CON register). FIGURE 10-2: COMPARE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM 10.2.4 Set CCP1IF Interrupt Flag (PIR2) 4 CCPR1H CCPR1L Q S R Output Logic Match TRIS Output Enable Comparator TMR1H TMR1L Special Event Trigger 10.2.1 SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER When Special Event Trigger mode is chosen (CCP1M<3:0> = 1011), the CCP1 module does the following: CCP1M<3:0> Mode Select CCP1 Pin SOFTWARE INTERRUPT MODE CCP1 PIN CONFIGURATION The user must configure the CCP1 pin as an output by clearing the associated TRIS bit. • Resets Timer1 • Starts an ADC conversion if ADC is enabled The CCP1 module does not assert control of the CCP1 pin in this mode. The Special Event Trigger output of the CCP1 occurs immediately upon a match between the TMR1H, TMR1L register pair and the CCPR1H, CCPR1L register pair. The TMR1H, TMR1L register pair is not reset until the next rising edge of the Timer1 clock. The Special Event Trigger output starts an A/D conversion (if the A/D module is enabled). This allows the CCPR1H, CCPR1L register pair to effectively provide a 16-bit programmable period register for Timer1. TABLE 10-2: SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER Device Note: Clearing the CCP1CON register will force the CCP1 compare output latch to the default low level. This is not the PORT I/O data latch. PIC16F753 PIC16HV753 CCP1 CCP1 Refer to Section 12.0 “Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module” for more information. Note 1: The Special Event Trigger from the CCP module does not set interrupt flag bit TMR1IF of the PIR1 register. 2: Removing the match condition by changing the contents of the CCPR1H and CCPR1L register pair, between the clock edge that generates the Special Event Trigger and the clock edge that generates the Timer1 Reset, will preclude the Reset from occurring. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 83 PIC16F753/HV753 10.2.5 COMPARE DURING SLEEP The Compare mode is dependent upon the system clock (FOSC) for proper operation. Since FOSC is shut down during Sleep mode, the Compare mode will not function properly during Sleep. TABLE 10-3: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH COMPARE Name Bit 7 Bit 6 CCP1CON — — Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 DC1B<1:0> Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 CCP1M<3:0> Register on Page 87 CCPR1L CCPR1L<7:0> 81 CCPR1H CCPR1H<7:0> 81 INTCON PIE1 GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF 19 TMR1GIE ADIE — — HLTMR2IE HLTMR1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 20 PIE2 — — C2IE C1IE — COG1IE — CCP1IE 21 PIR1 TMR1GIF ADIF — — HLTMR2IF HLTMR1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF 22 — — C2IF C1IF 23 PIR2 T1CON T1GCON TMR1CS<1:0> TMR1GE T1GPOL T1CKPS<1:0> T1GTM T1GSPM — COG1IF — CCP1IF T1OSCEN T1SYNC — TMR1ON T1GGO/ DONE T1GVAL T1GSS<1:0> TMR1H TMR1H<7:0> TMR1L TMR1L<7:0> TRISA — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3(1) 71 72 63* 63* TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 46 Legend: — = Unimplemented location, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by Compare mode. * Page provides register information. Note 1: TRISA3 always reads ‘1’. DS40001709A-page 84 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 10.3 PWM Overview FIGURE 10-3: Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) is a scheme that provides power to a load by switching quickly between fully on and fully off states. The PWM signal resembles a square wave where the high portion of the signal is considered the on state and the low portion of the signal is considered the off state. The high portion, also known as the pulse width, can vary in time and is defined in steps. A larger number of steps applied, which lengthens the pulse width, also supplies more power to the load. Lowering the number of steps applied, which shortens the pulse width, supplies less power. The PWM period is defined as the duration of one complete cycle or the total amount of on and off time combined. CCP1 PWM OUTPUT SIGNAL Period Pulse Width TMR2 = PR2 TMR2 = CCPR1H:CCP1CON<5:4> TMR2 = 0 FIGURE 10-4: SIMPLIFIED PWM BLOCK DIAGRAM PWM resolution defines the maximum number of steps that can be present in a single PWM period. A higher resolution allows for more precise control of the pulse width time and in turn the power that is applied to the load. Duty Cycle Registers The term duty cycle describes the proportion of the on time to the off time and is expressed in percentages, where 0% is fully off and 100% is fully on. A lower duty cycle corresponds to less power applied and a higher duty cycle corresponds to more power applied. CCPR1H(2) (Slave) CCP1CON<5:4> CCPR1L CCP1 R Comparator TMR2 (1) Q S Figure 10-3 shows a typical waveform of the PWM signal. TRIS Comparator 10.3.1 STANDARD PWM OPERATION The standard PWM mode generates a Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) signal on the CCP1 pin with up to 10 bits of resolution. The period, duty cycle, and resolution are controlled by the following registers: • • • • PR2 Note 1: PR2 registers T2CON registers CCPR1L registers CCP1CON registers 2: Clear Timer, toggle CCP1 pin and latch duty cycle The 8-bit timer TMR2 register is concatenated with the 2-bit internal system clock (FOSC), or 2 bits of the prescaler, to create the 10-bit time base. In PWM mode, CCPR1H is a read-only register. Figure 10-4 shows a simplified block diagram of PWM operation. Note 1: The corresponding TRIS bit must be cleared to enable the PWM output on the CCP1 pin. 2: Clearing the CCP1CON register will relinquish control of the CCP1 pin. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 85 PIC16F753/HV753 10.3.2 SETUP FOR PWM OPERATION The following steps should be taken when configuring the CCP1 module for standard PWM operation: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Disable the CCP1 pin output driver by setting the associated TRIS bit. Load the PR2 register with the PWM period value. Configure the CCP1 module for the PWM mode by loading the CCP1CON register with the appropriate values. Load the CCPR1L register and the DC1B<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON register, with the PWM duty cycle value. Configure and start Timer2: • Clear the TMR2IF interrupt flag bit of the PIR1 register. See Note below. • Configure the T2CKPS bits of the T2CON register with the Timer prescale value. • Enable the Timer by setting the TMR2ON bit of the T2CON register. Enable PWM output pin: • Wait until the Timer overflows and the TMR2IF bit of the PIR1 register is set. See Note below. • Enable the CCP1 pin output driver by clearing the associated TRIS bit. Note: 10.3.3 In order to send a complete duty cycle and period on the first PWM output, the above steps must be included in the setup sequence. If it is not critical to start with a complete PWM signal on the first output, then step 6 may be ignored. When TMR2 is equal to PR2, the following three events occur on the next increment cycle: • TMR2 is cleared • The CCP1 pin is set. (Exception: If the PWM duty cycle = 0%, the pin will not be set.) • The PWM duty cycle is latched from CCPR1L into CCPR1H. Note: 10.3.4 The Timer postscaler (see Section 8.1 “Timer2 Operation”) is not used in the determination of the PWM frequency. PWM DUTY CYCLE The PWM duty cycle is specified by writing a 10-bit value to multiple registers: CCPR1L register and DC1B<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON register. The CCPR1L contains the eight MSbs and the DC1B<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON register contain the two LSbs. CCPR1L and DC1B<1:0> bits of the CCP1CON register can be written to at any time. The duty cycle value is not latched into CCPR1H until after the period completes (i.e., a match between PR2 and TMR2 registers occurs). While using the PWM, the CCPR1H register is read-only. Equation 10-2 is used to calculate the PWM pulse width. Equation 10-3 is used to calculate the PWM duty cycle ratio. EQUATION 10-2: PULSE WIDTH Pulse Width = CCPR1L:CCP1CON<5:4> T OSC (TMR2 Prescale Value) PWM PERIOD The PWM period is specified by the PR2 register of Timer2. The PWM period can be calculated using the formula of Equation 10-1. EQUATION 10-1: PWM PERIOD PWM Period = PR2 + 1 4 T OSC (TMR2 Prescale Value) Note 1: TOSC = 1/FOSC EQUATION 10-3: DUTY CYCLE RATIO CCPRxL:CCPxCON<5:4> Duty Cycle Ratio = ----------------------------------------------------------------------4 PRx + 1 The CCPR1H register and a 2-bit internal latch are used to double buffer the PWM duty cycle. This double buffering is essential for glitchless PWM operation. The 8-bit timer TMR2 register is concatenated with either the 2-bit internal system clock (FOSC), or 2 bits of the prescaler, to create the 10-bit time base. The system clock is used if the Timer2 prescaler is set to 1:1. When the 10-bit time base matches the CCPR1H and 2-bit latch, then the CCP1 pin is cleared (see Figure 10-4). DS40001709A-page 86 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 10.4 Register Definitions: CCP Control REGISTER 10-1: U-0 CCP1CON: CCP1 CONTROL REGISTER U-0 — R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 DC1B<1:0> — R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 CCP1M<3:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Reset ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-6 bit 5-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DC1B<1:0>: PWM Duty Cycle Least Significant bits Capture mode: Unused Compare mode: Unused PWM mode: These bits are the two LSbs of the PWM duty cycle. The eight MSbs are found in CCPR1L. bit 3-0 CCP1M<3:0>: CCP1 Mode Select bits 0000 = 0001 = 0010 = 0011 = Capture/Compare/PWM off (resets CCP1 module) Reserved Compare mode: toggle output on match Reserved 0100 = 0101 = 0110 = 0111 = Capture mode: every falling edge Capture mode: every rising edge Capture mode: every 4th rising edge Capture mode: every 16th rising edge 1000 = 1001 = 1010 = 1011 = Compare mode: initialize CCP1 pin low; set output on compare match (set CCP1IF) Compare mode: initialize CCP1 pin high; clear output on compare match (set CCP1IF) Compare mode: generate software interrupt only; CCP1 pin reverts to I/O state Compare mode: Special Event Trigger (CCP1 resets Timer, sets CCP1IF bit, and starts A/D conversion if A/D module is enabled) 11xx = PWM mode 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 87 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 88 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 11.0 COMPLEMENTARY OUTPUT GENERATOR (COG) MODULE The primary purpose of the Complementary Output Generator (COG) is to convert a single output PWM signal into a two output complementary PWM signal. The COG can also convert two separate input events into a single or complementary PWM output. The COG PWM frequency and duty cycle are determined by a rising event input and a falling event input. The rising event and falling event may be the same source. Sources may be synchronous or asynchronous to the COG_clock. The rate at which the rising event occurs determines the PWM frequency. The time from the rising event input to the falling event input determines the duty cycle. A selectable clock input is used to generate the phase delay, blanking and dead-band times. A simplified block diagram of the COG is shown in Figure 11-1. The COG module has the following features: 11.1.1 11.1.2 PUSH-PULL MODE In Push-Pull mode, the COG generates a single PWM output that alternates every PWM period, between the two COG output pins. The output drive activates with the rising input event and terminates with the falling event input. Each rising event starts a new period and causes the output to switch to the COG pin not used in the previous period. A typical push-pull waveform generated from a single CCP1 input is shown in Figure 11-6. 11.1.3 ALL MODES In addition to generating a complementary output from a single PWM input, the COG can also generate PWM waveforms from a periodic rising event and a separate falling event. In this case, the falling event is usually derived from analog feedback within the external PWM driver circuit. In this configuration, high-power switching transients may trigger a false falling event that needs to be blanked out. The COG can be configured to blank falling (and rising) event inputs for a period of time immediately following the rising (and falling) event drive output. This is referred to as input blanking and is described in Section 11.6 “Blanking Control”. It may be necessary to guard against the possibility of circuit faults. In this case, the active drive must be terminated before the Fault condition causes damage. This is referred to as auto-shutdown and is described in Section 11.8 “Auto-shutdown Control”. A feedback falling event arriving too late or not at all can be terminated with auto-shutdown or by enabling one of the Hardware Limit Timer (HLT) event inputs. See Section 9.0 “Hardware Limit Timer (HLT) Module” for more information about the HLT. Fundamental Operation SYNCHRONOUS PWM MODE In synchronous PWM mode, the COG generates a two output complementary PWM waveform from rising and falling event sources. In the simplest configuration, the rising and falling event sources have the same signal, which is a PWM signal with the desired period and duty 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. A typical operating waveform, with dead band, generated from a single CCP1 input is shown in Figure 11-4. Push-Pull mode is selected by setting the GxMD bit of the COGxCON0 register. • Two modes of operation: - Synchronous PWM - Push-pull • Selectable clock source • Independently selectable rising event sources • Independently selectable falling event sources • Independently selectable edge or level event sensitivity • Independent output enables • Independent output polarity selection • Phase delay with independent rising and falling delay times • Dead-band control with: - Independent rising and falling event dead-band times - Synchronous and asynchronous timing • Blanking control with independent rising and falling event blanking times • Auto-shutdown control with: - Independently selectable shutdown sources - Auto-restart enable - Auto-shutdown pin override control (high, low, off, and High-Z) 11.1 cycle. The COG converts this single PWM input into a dual complementary PWM output. The frequency and duty cycle of the dual PWM output match those of the single input PWM signal. The off-to-on transition of each output can be delayed from the on-to-off transition of the other output, thereby creating a time immediately after the PWM transition where neither output is driven. This is referred to as dead time and is covered in Section 11.5 “Dead-Band Control”. The COG can be configured to operate in phase delayed conjunction with another PWM. The active drive cycle is delayed from the rising event by a phase delay timer. Phase delay is covered in more detail in Section 11.7 “Phase Delay”. A typical operating waveform, with phase delay and dead band, generated from a single CCP1 input, is shown in Figure 11-5. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 89 SIMPLIFIED COG BLOCK DIAGRAM HFINTOSC 10 Fosc/4 Fosc 01 00 GxCS<1:0> Reserved HLTimer2 HLTimer1 TImer2=PR2 COGxFLT CCP1 C2OUT C1OUT COG_clock GxASD0L<1:0> Rising Input Block src7 src6 src5 src4 src3 src2 src1 src0 Rising Dead-band Block clock Reset Dominates rising_event signal_out signal_in S Q 0 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Write GxASDE High 1 COG1OUT0 GxPOL0 R Q GxASD1L<1:0> count_en ‘0 ’ ‘1 ’ High-Z Falling Dead-band Block clock clock signal_out signal_in falling_event Push-Pull 0 00 01 11 10 GxOE1 1 COG1OUT1 0 1 GxPOL1 D Q count_en Q COGxFLT GxASDSFLT C1OUT GxASDSC1 C2OUT GxASDSC2 HLTimer2 output GxASDSHLT2 HLTimer1 output GxASDSHLT1 GxOE0 0 1 GxMD src7 src6 src5 src4 src3 src2 src1 src0 00 01 11 10 clock Falling Input Block Reserved HLTimer2 HLTimer1 Timer2=PR2 COGxFLT CCP1 C2OUT C1OUT ‘0 ’ ‘1 ’ High-Z GxEN Auto-shutdown source GxARSEN Write GxASDE Low S Q R Set Dominates S D Q GxASDE PIC16F753/HV753 DS40001709A-page 90 FIGURE 11-1: PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 11-2: COG (RISING/FALLING) INPUT BLOCK clock GxPH(R/F)<3:0> Blanking = Cnt/Clr count_en Phase Delay GxBLK(F/R)<3:0> src7 Gx(R/F)IS7 src6 Gx(R/F)SIM7 Gx(R/F)IS6 src5 Gx(R/F)SIM6 Gx(R/F)IS5 src4 Gx(R/F)SIM5 Gx(R/F)IS4 src3 Gx(R/F)SIM4 Gx(R/F)IS3 src2 Gx(R/F)SIM3 Gx(R/F)IS2 src1 Gx(R/F)SIM2 Gx(R/F)IS1 src0 Gx(R/F)SIM1 Gx(R/F)IS0 Gx(R/F)SIM0 FIGURE 11-3: D Q 1 LE 0 D Q 1 LE 0 D Q 1 LE 0 D Q 1 LE 0 D Q 1 LE 0 D Q 1 LE 0 D Q 1 LE 0 D Q 1 LE 0 (rising/falling)_event COG (RISING/FALLING) DEAD-BAND BLOCK Gx(R/F)DBTS clock 0 1 Synchronous Delay = Cnt/Clr GxDBR<3:0> 0 1 Asynchronous Delay Chain signal_out signal_in 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 91 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 11-4: TYPICAL COG OPERATION WITH CCP1 COG_clock Source CCP1 COGxOUT0 Rising Source Dead Band Falling Source Dead Band Falling Source Dead Band COGxOUT1 FIGURE 11-5: COG OPERATION WITH CCP1 AND PHASE DELAY COG_clock Source CCP1 COGxOUT0 Falling Source Dead Band Phase Delay Rising Source Dead Band COGxOUT1 FIGURE 11-6: Falling Source Dead Band COG OPERATION IN PUSH-PULL MODE WITH CCP1 CCP1 COGxOUT0 COGxOUT1 DS40001709A-page 92 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 11.2 Clock Sources output stays low and without a high-to-low transition to trigger the edge sense, the drive of the COG output will be stuck in a constant drive-on condition. See Figure 11-7. The COG_clock is used as the reference clock to the various timers in the peripheral. Timers that use the COG_clock include: FIGURE 11-7: • Rising and falling dead-band time • Rising and falling blanking time • Rising and falling event phase delay Rising (CCP1) Clock sources available for selection include: Falling (C1OUT) • 8 MHz HFINTOSC (active during Sleep) • Instruction clock (Fosc/4) • System clock (Fosc) COGOUT Edge Sensitive Selectable Event Sources The COG uses any combination of independently selectable event sources to generate the complementary waveform. Sources fall into two categories: Rising (CCP1) Falling (C1OUT) • Rising event sources • Falling event sources C1IN- The rising event sources are selected by setting bits in the COGxRIS register (Register 11-3). The falling event sources are selected by setting bits in the COGxFIS register (Register 11-5). All selected sources are ‘OR’d together to generate the corresponding event signal. Refer to Figure 11-2. COGOUT 11.3.1 EDGE VS. LEVEL SENSING Event input detection may be selected as level or edge-sensitive. The Detection mode is individually selectable for every source. Rising source detection modes are selected with the COGxRSIM register (Register 11-4). Falling source detection modes are selected with the COGxFSIM register (Register 11-6). A set bit enables edge detection for the corresponding event source. A cleared bit enables level detection. In general, events that are driven from a periodic source should be edge-detected and events that are derived from voltage thresholds at the target circuit should be level-sensitive. Consider the following two examples: 1. 2. hyst C1IN- The clock source is selected with the GxCS<1:0> bits of the COGxCON1 register (Register 11-2). 11.3 The first example is an application in which the period is determined by a 50% duty cycle clock and the COG output duty cycle is determined by a voltage level fed back through a comparator. If the clock input is level sensitive, duty cycles less than 50% will exhibit erratic operation. The second example is similar to the first, except that the duty cycle is close to 100%. The feedback comparator high-to-low transition trips the COG drive off, but almost immediately the period source turns the drive back on. If the off cycle is short enough, the comparator input may not reach the low side of the hysteresis band precluding an output change. The comparator 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. EDGE VS. LEVEL SENSE hyst Level Sensitive 11.3.2 RISING EVENT The rising event starts the PWM output active duty cycle period. The rising event is the low-to-high transition of the rising_event output. When the rising event phase delay and dead-band time values are zero, the COGxOUT0 output starts immediately. Otherwise, the COGxOUT0 output is delayed. The rising event source causes all the following actions: • • • • • Start rising event phase delay counter (if enabled). Clear COGxOUT1 after phase delay. Start falling event input blanking (if enabled). Start dead-band delay (if enabled). Set COGxOUT0 output after dead-band delay expires. 11.3.3 FALLING EVENT The falling event terminates the PWM output active duty cycle period. The falling event is the high-to-low transition of the falling_event output. When the falling event phase delay and dead-band time values are zero, the COGxOUT1 output starts immediately. Otherwise, the COGxOUT1 output is delayed. The falling event source causes all the following actions: • • • • • Start falling event phase delay counter (if enabled). Clear COGxOUT0. Start rising event input blanking (if enabled). Start falling event dead-band delay (if enabled). Set COGxOUT1 output after dead-band delay expires. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 93 PIC16F753/HV753 11.4 Output Control 11.5.1 Upon disabling, or immediately after enabling the COG module, the complementary drive is configured with COGxOUT0 drive inactive and COGxOUT1 drive active. 11.4.1 OUTPUT ENABLES Each COG output pin has an individual output enable control. Output enables are selected with the GxOE0 and GxOE1 bits of the COGxCON0 register (Register 11-1). When an output enable control is cleared, the module asserts no control over the pin. When an output enable is set, the override value or PWM waveform is applied to the pin per the port priority selection. The device pin output enable control bits are independent of the GxEN bit of the COGxCON0 register, which enables the COG. When GxEN is cleared, and shutdown is not active, the Reset state PWM levels are present on the COG output pins. The PWM levels are affected by the polarity controls. If shutdown is active when GxEN is cleared, the shutdown override levels will be present on the COG output pins. Note that setting the GxASE bit while the GxEN bit is cleared will activate shutdown which can only be cleared by either a rising event while the GxEN bit is set, or a device Reset. 11.4.2 POLARITY CONTROL The polarity of each COG output can be selected independently. When the output polarity bit is set, the corresponding output is active-low. Clearing the output polarity bit configures the corresponding output as active-high. However, polarity does not affect the shutdown override levels. Output polarity is selected with the GxPOL0 and GxPOL1 bits of the COGxCON0 register (Register 11-1). 11.5 Dead-Band Control ASYNCHRONOUS DELAY CHAIN DEAD-BAND DELAY Asynchronous dead-band delay is determined by the time it takes the input to propagate through a series of delay elements. Each delay element is a nominal five nanoseconds. Set the COGxDBR register (Register 11-9) value to the desired number of delay elements in the COGxOUT0 dead band. Set the COGxDBF register (Register 11-10) value to the desired number of delay elements in the COGxOUT1 dead band. When the value is zero, dead-band delay is disabled. 11.5.2 SYNCHRONOUS COUNTER DEAD-BAND DELAY Synchronous counter dead band is timed by counting COG_clock periods from zero up to the value in the dead-band count register. Use Equation 11-1 to calculate dead-band times. Set the COGxDBR count register value to obtain the desired dead-band time of the COGxOUT0 output. Set the COGxDBF count register value to obtain the desired dead-band time of the COGxOUT1 output. When the value is zero, dead-band delay is disabled. 11.5.3 SYNCHRONOUS COUNTER DEAD-BAND TIME UNCERTAINTY When the rising and falling events that trigger the dead-band counters come from asynchronous inputs, it creates uncertainty in the synchronous counter dead-band time. The maximum uncertainty is equal to one COG_clock period. Refer to Equation 11-1 for more detail. When event input sources are asynchronous with no phase delay, use the asynchronous delay chain dead-band mode to avoid the dead-band time uncertainty. The dead-band control provides for non-overlapping PWM output signals to prevent shoot-through current in the external power switches. The COG contains two dead-band timers. One dead-band timer is used for rising event dead-band control. The other is used for falling event dead-band control. Timer modes are selectable as either: • Asynchronous delay chain • Synchronous counter The dead-band Timer mode is selected for the COGxOUT0 and COGxOUT1 dead-band times with the respective GxRDBTS and GxFDBTS bits of the COGxCON1 register (Register 11-2). DS40001709A-page 94 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 11.5.4 RISING EVENT DEAD BAND Rising event dead band adds a delay between the COGxOUT1 signal deactivation and the COGxOUT0 signal activation. The rising event dead-band time starts when the rising_event output goes true. See Section 11.5.1, Asynchronous Delay Chain Dead-band Delay and Section 11.5.2, Synchronous Counter Dead-band Delay for more information on setting the rising edge dead-band time. 11.5.5 FALLING EVENT DEAD BAND Falling event dead band adds a delay between the COGxOUT1 signal deactivation and the COGxOUT0 signal activation. The falling event dead-band time starts when the falling_event output goes true. See Section 11.5.1, Asynchronous Delay Chain Dead-band Delay and Section 11.5.2, Synchronous Counter Dead-band Delay for more information on setting the rising edge dead-band time. 11.5.6 DEAD-BAND OVERLAP There are two cases of dead-band overlap: Rising-to-Falling Overlap In this case, the falling event occurs while the rising event dead-band counter is still counting. When this happens, the COGxOUT0 drive is suppressed and the dead band extends by the falling event dead-band time. At the termination of the extended dead-band time, the COGxOUT1 drive goes true. 11.5.6.2 Falling-to-Rising Overlap In this case, the rising event occurs while the falling event dead-band counter is still counting. When this happens, the COGxOUT1 drive is suppressed and the dead band extends by the rising event dead-band time. At the termination of the extended dead-band time, the COGxOUT0 drive goes true. 11.6 Blanking Control Input blanking is a function, whereby the event inputs can be masked or blanked for a short period of time. This is to prevent electrical transients caused by the turn-on/off of power components from generating a false input event. The COG contains two blanking counters: one triggered by the rising event and the other triggered by the falling event. The counters are cross-coupled with the events they are blanking. The falling event blanking counter is used to blank rising input events and the rising event blanking counter is used to blank 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Blanking is timed by counting COG_clock periods from zero up to the value in the blanking count register. Use Equation 11-1 to calculate blanking times. 11.6.1 FALLING EVENT BLANKING OF RISING EVENT INPUTS The falling event blanking counter inhibits rising event inputs from triggering a rising event. The falling event blanking time starts when the rising event output drive goes false. The falling event blanking time is set by the value contained in the COGxBLKF register (Register 11-12). Blanking times are calculated using the formula shown in Equation 11-1. When the COGxBLKF value is zero, the falling event blanking is disabled and the blanking counter output is true, thereby allowing the event signal to pass straight through to the event trigger circuit. 11.6.2 • Rising-to-falling • Falling-to-rising 11.5.6.1 falling input events. Once started, blanking extends for the time specified by the corresponding blanking counter. RISING EVENT BLANKING OF FALLING EVENT INPUTS The rising event blanking counter inhibits falling event inputs from triggering a falling event. The rising event blanking time starts when the falling event output drive goes false. The rising event blanking time is set by the value contained in the COGxBLKR register (Register 11-11). When the COGxBLKR value is zero, the rising event blanking is disabled and the blanking counter output is true, thereby allowing the event signal to pass straight through to the event trigger circuit. 11.6.3 BLANKING TIME UNCERTAINTY When the rising and falling sources that trigger the blanking counters are asynchronous to the COG_clock, it creates uncertainty in the blanking time. The maximum uncertainty is equal to one COG_clock period. Refer to Equation 11-1 and Example 11-2 for more detail. 11.7 Phase Delay It is possible to delay the assertion of either or both the rising event and falling event. This is accomplished by placing a non-zero value in COGxPHR or COGxPHF phase delay count register, respectively (Register 11-13 and Register 11-14). Refer to Figure 11-5 for COG operation with CCP1 and phase delay. The delay from the input rising event signal switching to the actual assertion of the events is calculated the same as the dead-band and blanking delays. Please see Equation 11-1. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 95 PIC16F753/HV753 When the phase delay count value is zero, phase delay is disabled and the phase delay counter output is true, thereby allowing the event signal to pass straight through to complementary output driver flop. 11.7.1 CUMULATIVE UNCERTAINTY It is not possible to create more than one COG_clock of uncertainty by successive stages. Consider that the phase delay stage comes after the blanking stage, the dead-band stage comes after either the blanking or phase delay stages, and the blanking stage comes after the dead-band stage. When the preceding stage is enabled, the output of that stage is necessarily synchronous with the COG_clock, which removes any possibility of uncertainty in the succeeding stage. EQUATION 11-1: EQUATION 11-2: Given: Count = Ah = 10d F COG_Clock = 8MHz Therefore: 1 T uncertainty = -------------------------F COG_clock 1 = --------------- = 125ns 8MHz Proof: PHASE, DEAD-BAND AND BLANKING TIME CALCULATION Count T min = -------------------------F COG_clock = 125ns 10d = 1.25s Count + 1 T max = -------------------------F COG_clock T min = Count F COG_clock T max Also: T uncertainty = 125ns 10d + 1 Count + 1 = -------------------------F COG_clock T uncertainty = T max – T min = 1.375s Therefore: T uncertainty = T max – T min 1 = -------------------------F COG_clock = 1.375s – 1.25s = 125ns Where: T Count Rising Phase Delay COGxPHR Falling Phase Delay COGxPHF Rising Dead Band COGxDBR Falling Dead Band COGxDBF Rising Event Blanking COGxBLKR Falling Event Blanking COGxBLKF DS40001709A-page 96 TIMER UNCERTAINTY Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 11.8 Auto-shutdown Control 11.8.2 Auto-shutdown is a method to immediately override the COG output levels with specific overrides that allow for safe shutdown of the circuit. The shutdown state can be either cleared automatically or held until cleared by software. In either case, the shutdown overrides remain in effect until the first rising event after the shutdown is cleared. 11.8.1 SHUTDOWN The shutdown state can be entered by either of the following two mechanisms: • Software generated • External Input 11.8.1.1 PIN OVERRIDE LEVELS The levels driven to the output pins, while the shutdown is active, are controlled by the GxASD0L<1:0> and GxASD1L<1:0> bits of the COGxASD0 register (Register 11-7). GxASD0L<1:0> controls the GxOUT0 override level and GxASD1L<1:0> controls the GxOUT1 override level. There are four override options for each output: • • • • Forced low Forced high Tri-state PWM inactive state (same state as that caused by a falling event) Note: Software Generated Shutdown The polarity control does not apply to the forced low and high override levels. Setting the GxASDE bit of the COGxASD0 register (Register 11-7) will force the COG into the shutdown state. 11.8.3 When auto-restart is disabled, the shutdown state will persist until the first rising event after the GxASDE bit is cleared by software. • Software controlled • Auto-restart When auto-restart is enabled, the GxASDE bit will clear automatically and resume operation on the first rising event after the shutdown input clears. See Figure 11-8 and Section 11.8.3.2 “Auto-Restart”. 11.8.1.2 External Shutdown Source External shutdown inputs provide the fastest way to safely suspend COG operation in the event of a Fault condition. When any of the selected shutdown inputs goes true, the output drive latches are reset and the COG outputs immediately go to the selected override levels without software delay. Any combination of the input sources can be selected to cause a shutdown condition. Shutdown input sources include: • • • • • HLTimer1 output HLTimer2 output C2OUT (low true) C1OUT (low true) COG1FLT pin (low true) AUTO-SHUTDOWN RESTART After an auto-shutdown event has occurred, there are two ways to have the module resume operation: The restart method is selected with the GxARSEN bit of the COGxASD0 register. Waveforms of a software controlled automatic restart are shown in Figure 11-8. 11.8.3.1 Software Controlled Restart When the GxARSEN bit of the COGxASD0 register is cleared, software must clear the GxASDE bit to restart COG operation after an auto-shutdown event. The COG will resume operation on the first rising event after the GxASDE bit is cleared. Clearing the shutdown state requires all selected shutdown inputs to be false, otherwise, the GxASDE bit will remain set. 11.8.3.2 Auto-Restart When the GxARSEN bit of the COGxASD0 register is set, the COG will restart from the auto-shutdown state automatically. The GxASDE bit will clear automatically and the COG will resume operation on the first rising event after all selected shutdown inputs go false. Shutdown inputs are selected independently with bits of the COGxASD1 register (Register 11-8). Note: Shutdown inputs are level-sensitive, not edge-sensitive. The shutdown state cannot be cleared as long as the shutdown input level persists, except by disabling auto-shutdown. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 97 DS40001709A-page 98 Preliminary Operating State COGxOUT1 COGxOUT0 GxASDL1 GxASDL0 GxASDE Shutdown Input Normal Output 3 Normal Output Next rising event Software Controlled Restart Shutdown Cleared in software 2 Shutdown Cleared in hardware 4 Auto-Restart Normal Output Next rising event 5 FIGURE 11-8: GxARSEN CCP1 1 PIC16F753/HV753 AUTO-SHUTDOWN WAVEFORM – CCP1 AS RISING AND FALLING EVENT INPUT SOURCE 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 11.9 Buffer Updates 11.12 Configuring the COG Changes to the phase, dead-band, and blanking count registers need to occur simultaneously during COG operation to avoid unintended operation that may occur as a result of delays between each register write. This is accomplished with the GxLD bit of the COGxCON0 register and double buffering of the phase, blanking, and dead-band count registers. Before the COG module is enabled, writing the count registers loads the count buffers without need of the GxLD bit. However, when the COG is enabled, the count buffers updates are suspended after writing the count registers until after the GxLD bit is set. When the GxLD bit is set, the phase, dead-band, and blanking register values are transferred to the corresponding buffers synchronous with COG operation. The GxLD bit is cleared by hardware when the transfer is complete. 11.10 Alternate Pin Selection 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. The COGxOUT0, COGxOUT1 and COGxFLT functions can be directed to alternate pins with control bits of the APFCON register. Refer to Register 5-1. Note: The following steps illustrate how to properly configure the COG to ensure a synchronous start with the rising event input: The default COG outputs have high drive strength capability, whereas the alternate outputs do not. 8. 9. 11.11 Operation During Sleep The COG continues to operate in Sleep provided that the COG_clock, rising event, and falling event sources remain active. The HFINTSOC remains active during Sleep when the COG is enabled and the HFINTOSC is selected as the COG_clock source. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary Configure the desired COGxFLT input, COGxOUT0 and COGxOUT1 pins with the corresponding bits in the APFCON register. Clear all ANSELA register bits associated with pins that are used for COG functions. Ensure that the TRIS control bits corresponding to COGxOUT0 and COGxOUT1 are set so that both are configured as inputs. These will be set as outputs later. Clear the GxEN bit, if not already cleared. Set desired dead-band times with the COGxDBR and COGxDBF registers. Set desired blanking times with the COGxBLKR and COGxBLKF registers. Set desired phase delay with the COGxPHR and COGxPHF registers. Select the desired shutdown sources with the COGxASD1 register. Set up the following controls in COGxASD0 auto-shutdown register: • Select both output overrides to the desired levels (this is necessary, even if not using auto-shutdown because start-up will be from a shutdown state). • Set the GxASDE bit and clear the GxARSEN bit. Select the desired rising and falling event sources with the COGxRIS and COGxFIS registers. Select the desired rising and falling event modes with the COGxRSIM and COGxFSIM registers. Configure the following controls in the COGxCON1 register: • Select the desired clock source • Select the desired dead-band timing sources Configure the following controls in the COGxCON0 register: • Select the desired output polarities. • Set the output enables of the outputs to be used. Set the GxEN bit. Clear TRIS control bits corresponding to COGxOUT0 and COGxOUT1 to be used, thereby configuring those pins as outputs. If auto-restart is to be used, set the GxARSEN bit and the GxASDE will be cleared automatically. Otherwise, clear the GxASDE bit to start the COG. DS40001709A-page 99 PIC16F753/HV753 11.13 Register Definitions: COG Control REGISTER 11-1: COGxCON0: COG CONTROL REGISTER 0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 U-0 R/W-0/0 GxEN GxOE1 GxOE0 GxPOL1 GxPOL0 GxLD — GxMD bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7 GxEN: COGx Enable bit 1 = Module is enabled 0 = Module is disabled bit 6 GxOE1: COGxOUT1 Output Enable bit 1 = COGxOUT1 is available on associated I/O pin 0 = COGxOUT1 is not available on associated I/O pin bit 5 GxOE0: COGxOUT0 Output Enable bit 1 = COGxOUT0 is available on associated I/O pin 0 = COGxOUT0 is not available on associated I/O pin bit 4 GxPOL1: COGxOUT1 Output Polarity bit 1 = Output is inverted polarity 0 = Output is normal polarity bit 3 GxPOL0: COGxOUT0 Output Polarity bit 1 = Output is inverted polarity 0 = Output is normal polarity bit 2 GxLD: COGx Load Buffers bit 1 = Phase, blanking, and dead-band buffers to be loaded with register values on next input events 0 = Register to buffer transfer is complete bit 1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 GxMD: COGx Mode bit 1 = COG outputs operate in Push-Pull mode 0 = COG outputs operate in Synchronous mode DS40001709A-page 100 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-2: R/W-0/0 GxRDBTS COGxCON1: COG CONTROL REGISTER 1 R/W-0/0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 GxFDBTS — — — — R/W-0/0 bit 7 R/W-0/0 GxCS<1:0> bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7 GxRDBTS: COGx Rising Event Dead-band Timing Source Select bit 1 = Delay chain and COGxDBR are used for dead-band timing generation 0 = COGx_clk and COGxDBR are used for dead-band timing generation bit 6 GxFDBTS: COGx Falling Event Dead-band Timing Source Select bit 1 = Delay chain and COGxDF are used for dead-band timing generation 0 = COGx_clk and COGxDBF are used for dead-band timing generation bit 5-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1-0 GxCS<1:0>: COGx Clock Source Select bits 11 = Reserved 10 = HFINTOSC (stays active during Sleep) 01 = Fosc/4 00 = Fosc 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 101 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-3: COGxRIS: COG RISING EVENT INPUT SELECTION REGISTER U-0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 — GxRIHLT2 GxRIHLT1 GxRIT2M GxRIFLT GxRICCP1 GxRIC2 GxRIC1 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6 GxRIHLT2: COGx Rising Event Input Source 6 Enable bit 1 = HLTimer2 output is enabled as a rising event input 0 = HLTimer2 has no effect on the rising event bit 5 GxRIHLT1: COGx Rising Event Input Source 5 Enable bit 1 = HLTimer1 output is enabled as a rising event input 0 = HLTimer1 has no effect on the rising event bit 4 GxRIT2M: COGx Rising Event Input Source 4 Enable bit 1 = Timer2 match with PR2 is enabled as a rising event input 0 = Timer2 match with PR2 has no effect on the rising event bit 3 GxRIFLT: COGx Rising Event Input Source 3 Enable bit 1 = COGxFLT pin is enabled as a rising event input 0 = COGxFLT pin has no effect on the rising event bit 2 GxRICCP1: COGx Rising Event Input Source 2 Enable bit 1 = CCP1 output is enabled as a rising event input 0 = CCP1 has no effect on the rising event bit 1 GxRIC2: COGx Rising Event Input Source 1 Enable bit 1 = Comparator 2 output is enabled as a rising event input 0 = Comparator 2 output has no effect on the rising event bit 0 GxRIC1: COGx Rising Event Input Source 0 Enable bit 1 = Comparator 1 output is enabled as a rising event input 0 = Comparator 1 output has no effect on the rising event DS40001709A-page 102 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-4: COGxRSIM: COG RISING EVENT SOURCE INPUT MODE REGISTER U-0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 — GxRMHLT2 GxRMHLT1 GxRMT2M GxRMFLT GxRMCCP1 GxRMC2 GxRMC1 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6 GxRMHLT2: COGx Rising Event Input Source 6 Mode bit(1) GxRIHLT2 = 1: 1 = HLTimer2 low-to-high transition will cause a rising event after rising event phase delay 0 = HLTimer2 high level will cause an immediate rising event GxRIHLT2 = 0: HLTimer2 has no effect on rising event bit 5 GxRMHLT1: COGx Rising Event Input Source 5 Mode bit(1) GxRIHLT1 = 1: 1 = HLTimer1 low-to-high transition will cause a rising event after rising event phase delay 0 = HLTimer1 high level will cause an immediate rising event GxRIHLT1 = 0: HLTimer1 has no effect on rising event bit 4 GxRMT2M: COGx Rising Event Input Source 4 Mode bit(1) GxRIT2M = 1: 1 = Timer2 match with PR2 low-to-high transition will cause a rising event after rising event phase delay 0 = Timer2 match with PR2 high level will cause an immediate rising event GxRIT2M = 0: Timer2 match with PR2 has no effect on rising event bit 3 GxRMFLT: COGx Rising Event Input Source 3 Mode bit GxRIFLT = 1: 1 = COGxFLT pin low-to-high transition will cause a rising event after rising event phase delay 0 = COGxFLT pin high level will cause an immediate rising event GxRIFLT = 0: COGxFLT pin has no effect on rising event bit 2 GxRMCCP1: COGx Rising Event Input Source 2 Mode bit GxRICCP1 = 1: 1 = CCP1 low-to-high transition will cause a rising event after rising event phase delay 0 = CCP1 high level will cause an immediate rising event GxRICCP1 = 0: CCP1 has no effect on rising event bit 1 GxRMC2: COGx Rising Event Input Source 1 Mode bit GxRIC2 = 1: 1 = Comparator 2 low-to-high transition will cause a rising event after rising event phase delay 0 = Comparator 2 high level will cause an immediate rising event GxRIC2 = 0: Comparator 2 has no effect on rising event bit 0 GxRMC1: COGx Rising Event Input Source 0 Mode bit GxRIC1 = 1: 1 = Comparator 1 low-to-high transition will cause a rising event after rising event phase delay 0 = Comparator 1 high level will cause an immediate rising event GxRIC1 = 0: Comparator 1 has no effect on rising event Note 1: These sources are pulses and therefore the only benefit of Edge mode over Level mode is that they can be delayed by rising event phase delay. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 103 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-5: COGxFIS: COG FALLING EVENT INPUT SELECTION REGISTER U-0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 — GxFIHLT2 GxFIHLT1 GxFIT2M GxFIFLT GxFICCP1 GxFIC2 GxFIC1 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6 GxFIHLT2: COGx Falling Event Input Source 6 Enable bit 1 = HLTimer2 output is enabled as a falling event input 0 = HLTimer2 has no effect on the falling event bit 5 GxFIHLT1: COGx Falling Event Input Source 5 Enable bit 1 = HLTimer1 output is enabled as a falling event input 0 = HLTimer1 has no effect on the falling event bit 4 GxFIT2M: COGx Falling Event Input Source 4 Enable bit 1 = Timer2 match with PR2 is enabled as a falling event input 0 = Timer2 match with PR2 has no effect on the falling event bit 3 GxFIFLT: COGx Falling Event Input Source 3 Enable bit 1 = COGxFLT pin is enabled as a falling event input 0 = COGxFLT pin has no effect on the falling event bit 2 GxFICCP1: COGx Falling Event Input Source 2 Enable bit 1 = CCP1 output is enabled as a falling event input 0 = CCP1 has no effect on the falling event bit 1 GxFIC2: COGx Falling Event Input Source 1 Enable bit 1 = Comparator 2 output is enabled as a falling event input 0 = Comparator 2 output has no effect on the falling event bit 0 GxFIC1: COGx Falling Event Input Source 0 Enable bit 1 = Comparator 1 output is enabled as a falling event input 0 = Comparator 1 output has no effect on the falling event DS40001709A-page 104 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-6: COGxFSIM: COG FALLING EVENT SOURCE INPUT MODE REGISTER U-0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 — GxFMHLT2 GxFMHLT1 GxFMT2M GxFMFLT GxFMCCP1 GxFMC2 GxFMC1 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6 GxFMHLT2: COGx Falling Event Input Source 6 Mode bit(1) GxFIHLT2 = 1: 1 = HLTimer2 low-to-high transition will cause a falling event after falling event phase delay 0 = HLTimer2 high level will cause an immediate falling event GxFIHLT2 = 0: HLTimer2 has no effect on falling event bit 5 GxFMHLT1: COGx Falling Event Input Source 5 Mode bit(1) GxFIHLT1 = 1: 1 = HLTimer1 low-to-high transition will cause a falling event after falling event phase delay 0 = HLTimer1 high level will cause an immediate falling event GxFIHLT1 = 0: HLTimer1 has no effect on falling event bit 4 GxFMT2M: COGx Falling Event Input Source 4 Mode bit(1) GxFIT2M = 1: 1 = Timer2 match with PR2 low-to-high transition will cause a falling event after falling event phase delay 0 = Timer2 match with PR2 high level will cause an immediate falling event GxFIT2M = 0: Timer2 match with PR2 has no effect on falling event bit 3 GxFMFLT: COGx Falling Event Input Source 3 Mode bit GxFIFLT = 1: 1 = COGxFLT pin low-to-high transition will cause a falling event after falling event phase delay 0 = COGxFLT pin high level will cause an immediate falling event GxFIFLT = 0: COGxFLT pin has no effect on falling event bit 2 GxFMCCP1: COGx Falling Event Input Source 2 Mode bit GxFICCP1 = 1: 1 = CCP1 low-to-high transition will cause a falling event after falling event phase delay 0 = CCP1 high level will cause an immediate falling event GxFICCP1 = 0: CCP1 has no effect on falling event bit 1 GxFMC2: COGx Falling Event Input Source 1 Mode bit GxFIC2 = 1: 1 = Comparator 2 low-to-high transition will cause a falling event after falling event phase delay 0 = Comparator 2 high level will cause an immediate falling event GxFIC2 = 0: Comparator 2 has no effect on falling event bit 0 GxFMC1: COGx Falling Event Input Source 0 Mode bit GxFIC1 = 1: 1 = Comparator 1 low-to-high transition will cause a falling event after falling event phase delay 0 = Comparator 1 high level will cause an immediate falling event GxFIC1 = 0: Comparator 1 has no effect on falling event Note 1: These sources are pulses and therefore the only benefit of Edge mode over Level mode is that they can be delayed by falling event phase delay. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 105 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-7: COGxASD0: COG AUTO-SHUTDOWN CONTROL REGISTER 0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 GxASDE GxARSEN R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 GxASD1L<1:0> R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 GxASD0L<1:0> bit 7 U-0 U-0 — — bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7 GxASDE: Auto-Shutdown Event Status bit 1 = COG is in the shutdown state 0 = COG is either not in the shutdown state or will exit the shutdown state on the next rising event bit 6 GxARSEN: Auto-Restart Enable bit 1 = Auto-restart is enabled 0 = Auto-restart is disabled bit 5-4 GxASD1L<1:0>: COGxOUT1 Auto-Shutdown Override Level Select bits 11 = COGxOUT1 is tri-stated when shutdown is active 10 = The inactive state of the pin, including polarity, is placed on COGxOUT1 when shutdown is active 01 = A logic ‘1’ is placed on COGxOUT1 when shutdown is active 00 = A logic ‘0’ is placed on COGxOUT1 when shutdown is active bit 3-2 GxASD0L<1:0>: COGxOUT0 Auto-Shutdown Override Level Select bits 11 = COGxOUT0 is tri-stated when shutdown is active 10 = The inactive state of the pin, including polarity, is placed on COGxOUT0 when shutdown is active 01 = A logic ‘1’ is placed on COGxOUT0when shutdown is active 00 = A logic ‘0’ is placed on COGxOUT0when shutdown is active bit 1-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DS40001709A-page 106 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-8: COGxASD1: COG AUTO-SHUTDOWN CONTROL REGISTER 1 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 GxASDSHLT2 GxASDSHLT1 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 GxASDSC2 GxASDSC1 GxASDSFLT bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 GxASDSHLT2: COGx Auto-Shutdown Source Enable bit 4 1 = COGx is shutdown when HLTMR2 equals HLTPR2 0 = HLTimer 2 has no effect on shutdown bit 3 GxASDSHLT1: COGx Auto-Shutdown Source Enable bit 3 1 = COGx is shutdown when HLTMR1 equals HLTPR1 0 = HLTimer 1 has no effect on shutdown bit 2 GxASDSC2: COGx Auto-Shutdown Source Enable bit 2 1 = COGx is shutdown when Comparator 2 output is low 0 = Comparator 2 output has no effect on shutdown bit 1 GxASDSC1: COGx Auto-Shutdown Source Enable bit 1 1 = COGx is shutdown when Comparator 1 output is low 0 = Comparator 1 output has no effect on shutdown bit 0 GxASDSFLT: COGx Auto-Shutdown Source Enable bit 0 1 = COGx is shutdown when COGxFLT pin is low 0 = COGxFLT pin has no effect on shutdown 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 107 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-9: COGxDBR: COG RISING EVENT DEAD-BAND COUNT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u GxDBR<3:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 GxDBR<3:0>: Rising Event Dead-band Count Value bits GxRDBTS = 1: = Number of delay chain element periods to delay primary output after rising event GxRDBTS = 0: = Number of COGx clock periods to delay primary output after rising event REGISTER 11-10: COGxDBF: COG FALLING EVENT DEAD-BAND COUNT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u GxDBF<3:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 GxDBF<3:0>: Falling Event Dead-Band Count Value bits GxFDBTS = 1: = Number of delay chain element periods to delay complementary output after falling event input GxFDBTS = 0: = Number of COGx clock periods to delay complementary output after falling event input DS40001709A-page 108 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-11: COGxBLKR: COG RISING EVENT BLANKING COUNT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u GxBLKR<3:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 GxBLKR<3:0>: Rising Event Blanking Count Value bits = Number of COGx clock periods to inhibit falling event inputs REGISTER 11-12: COGxBLKF: COG FALLING EVENT BLANKING COUNT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u GxBLKF<3:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 GxBLKF<3:0>: Falling Event Blanking Count Value bits = Number of COGx clock periods to inhibit rising event inputs 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 109 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 11-13: COGxPHR: COG RISING EDGE PHASE DELAY COUNT REGISTER U-0 U-0 — — U-0 — U-0 R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u GxPHR<3:0> — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 GxPHR<3:0>: Rising Edge Phase Delay Count Value bits = Number of COGx clock periods to delay rising edge event REGISTER 11-14: COGxPHF: COG FALLING EDGE PHASE DELAY COUNT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u R/W-x/u GxPHF<3:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 GxPHF<3:0>: Falling Edge Phase Delay Count Value bits = Number of COGx clock periods to delay falling edge event DS40001709A-page 110 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 11-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH COG Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page — ANSA4 — ANSA2 ANSA1 ANSA0 48 — T1GSEL — — — — — — — — — — — G1PHF<3:0> 110 — — — — G1BLKR<3:0> 109 COG1BKF — — — — G1BLKF<3:0> 109 COG1DBR — — — — G1DBR<3:0> 108 COG1DBF — — — — G1DBF<3:0> COG1RIS — G1RIHLT2 G1RIHLT1 G1RIT2M G1RIFLT G1RICCP1 G1RIC2 G1RIC1 102 COG1RSIM — G1RMHLT2 G1RMHLT1 G1RMT2M G1RMFLT G1RMCCP1 G1RMC2 G1RMC1 103 COG1FIS — G1FIHLT2 G1FIHLT1 G1FIT2M G1FIFLT G1FICCP1 G1FIC2 G1FIC1 104 COG1FSIM — G1FMHLT2 G1FMHLT1 G1FMT2M G1FMFLT G1FMCCP1 G1FMC2 G1FMC1 105 COG1CON0 G1EN G1OE1 G1OE0 G1POL1 G1POL0 G1LD — G1MD COG1CON1 G1RDBTS G1FDBTS — — — — COG1ASD0 G1ASDE G1ARSEN COG1ASD1 — — — GIE PEIE T0IE LATA — — PIE2 — — PIR2 — TRISA — Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 ANSELA — — APFCON — — COG1PHR — COG1PHF COG1BKR INTCON Legend: G1ASD1L<1:0> G1PHR<3:0> 108 G1CS<1:0> 100 101 — — 106 G1ASDSC2 G1ASDSC1 G1ASDSFLT 107 IOCIF 19 G1ASD0L<1:0> G1ASDSHLT2 G1ASDSHLT1 44 110 INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF LATA5 LATA4 — LATA2 LATA1 LATA0 46 C2IE C1IE — COG1IE — CCP1IE 21 — C2IF C1IF — COG1IF — CCP1IF 23 — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3 TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 46 x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by COG. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 111 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 112 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 12.0 ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) MODULE Note: The Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) allows conversion of an analog input signal to a 10-bit binary representation of that signal. This device uses analog inputs, which are multiplexed into a single sample and hold circuit. The output of the sample and hold is connected to the input of the converter. The converter generates a 10-bit binary result via successive approximation and stores the conversion result into the ADC result registers (ADRESL and ADRESH). The ADRESL and ADRESH registers are read-only. The ADC voltage reference is software selectable to either VDD or a voltage applied to the external reference pins. The ADC can generate an interrupt upon completion of a conversion. This interrupt can be used to wake-up the device from Sleep. Figure 12-1 shows the block diagram of the ADC. FIGURE 12-1: ADC BLOCK DIAGRAM VDD ADPREF = 0 VREF+ AN0 0000 AN1 0001 AN2 0010 AN3 0011 AN4 0100 AN5 0101 AN6 0110 AN7 0111 Dac output 1110 Fixed Voltage Reference 1111 ADPREF = 1 A/D 10 GO/DONE ADFM 0 = Left Justify 1 = Right Justify ADON 10 Vss ADRESH ADRESL CHS<3:0> 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 113 PIC16F753/HV753 12.1 ADC Configuration 12.1.3 When configuring and using the ADC the following functions must be considered: • • • • • • Port configuration Channel selection ADC voltage reference selection ADC conversion clock source Interrupt control Results formatting 12.1.1 12.1.2 CONVERSION CLOCK The source of the conversion clock is software selectable via the ADCS bits of the ADCON1 register. There are seven possible clock options: PORT CONFIGURATION Analog voltages on any pin that is defined as a digital input may cause the input buffer to conduct excess current. CHANNEL SELECTION The CHS bits of the ADCON0 register determine which channel is connected to the sample and hold circuit. When changing channels, a delay is required before starting the next conversion. Refer to Section 12.2 “ADC Operation” for more information. DS40001709A-page 114 The ADPREF1 bit of the ADCON1 register provides control of the positive voltage reference. The positive voltage reference can be either VDD or an external voltage source. The negative voltage reference is always connected to the ground reference. 12.1.4 The ADC can be used to convert both analog and digital signals. When converting analog signals, the I/O pin should be configured for analog by setting the associated TRIS and ANSEL bits. See the corresponding port section for more information. Note: ADC VOLTAGE REFERENCE • • • • • • • FOSC/2 FOSC/4 FOSC/8 FOSC/16 FOSC/32 FOSC/64 FRC (dedicated internal oscillator) The time to complete one bit conversion is defined as TAD. One full 10-bit conversion requires 11 TAD periods as shown in Figure 12-2. For correct conversion, the appropriate TAD specification must be met. See A/D conversion requirements in Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications” for more information. Table 12-1 gives examples of appropriate ADC clock selections. Note: Preliminary Unless using the FRC, any changes in the system clock frequency will change the ADC clock frequency, which may adversely affect the ADC result. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 12-1: ADC CLOCK PERIOD (TAD) VS. DEVICE OPERATING FREQUENCIES (VDD > 3.0V) ADC Clock Period (TAD) ADC Clock Source Device Frequency (FOSC) ADCS<2:0> 20 MHz 8 MHz (2) 2.0 s 1.0 s(2) 4.0 s 2.0 s 8.0 s(3) 2.0 s 4.0 s 16.0 s(3) 4.0 s 8.0 s(3) 32.0 s(3) FOSC/2 000 100 ns 100 200 ns(2) 500 ns(2) 001 400 ns (2) (2) 800 ns (2) FOSC/16 101 FOSC/32 010 500 ns 1.0 s (3) FOSC/64 110 3.2 s FRC x11 2-6 s(1,4) Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 250 ns 1.6 s 1 MHz (2) FOSC/4 FOSC/8 4 MHz (2) 8.0 s 2-6 s(1,4) (3) 16.0 s 64.0 s(3) 2-6 s(1,4) 2-6 s(1,4) Shaded cells are outside of recommended range. The FRC source has a typical TAD time of 4 s for VDD > 3.0V. These values violate the minimum required TAD time. For faster conversion times, the selection of another clock source is recommended. When the device frequency is greater than 1 MHz, the FRC clock source is only recommended if the conversion will be performed during Sleep. FIGURE 12-2: ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERSION TAD CYCLES TCY to TAD TAD1 TAD2 TAD3 TAD4 TAD5 TAD6 TAD7 TAD8 TAD9 TAD10 TAD11 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 Conversion Starts Holding Capacitor is Disconnected from Analog Input (typically 100 ns) Set GO/DONE bit 12.1.5 ADRESH and ADRESL registers are loaded, GO bit is cleared, ADIF bit is set, Holding capacitor is connected to analog input INTERRUPTS The ADC module allows for the ability to generate an interrupt upon completion of an Analog-to-Digital conversion. The ADC interrupt flag is the ADIF bit in the PIR1 register. The ADC interrupt enable is the ADIE bit in the PIE1 register. The ADIF bit must be cleared in software. Note: The ADIF bit is set at the completion of every conversion, regardless of whether or not the ADC interrupt is enabled. This interrupt can be generated while the device is operating or while in Sleep. If the device is in Sleep, the interrupt will wake-up the device. Upon waking from Sleep, the next instruction following the SLEEP instruction is always executed. If the user is attempting to wake-up from Sleep and resume in-line code execution, the global interrupt must be disabled. If the global interrupt is enabled, execution will switch to the Interrupt Service Routine. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 115 PIC16F753/HV753 12.1.6 RESULT FORMATTING The 10-bit A/D conversion result can be supplied in two formats, left justified or right justified. The ADFM bit of the ADCON0 register controls the output format. Figure 12-4 shows the two output formats. FIGURE 12-3: 10-BIT A/D CONVERSION RESULT FORMAT ADRESH (ADFM = 0) ADRESL MSB LSB bit 7 bit 0 bit 7 10-bit A/D Result (ADFM = 1) Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ MSB bit 7 LSB bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ 12.2 12.2.1 12.2.2 ADC Operation 12.2.4 STARTING A CONVERSION The GO/DONE bit should not be set in the same instruction that turns on the ADC. Refer to Section 12.2.6 “A/D Conversion Procedure”. COMPLETION OF A CONVERSION When the conversion is complete, the ADC module will: • Clear the GO/DONE bit • Set the ADIF flag bit • Update the ADRESH:ADRESL registers with new conversion result 12.2.3 TERMINATING A CONVERSION If a conversion must be terminated before completion, the GO/DONE bit can be cleared in software. The ADRESH:ADRESL registers will not be updated with the partially complete Analog-to-Digital conversion sample. Instead, the ADRESH:ADRESL register pair will retain the value of the previous conversion. Additionally, a 2 TAD delay is required before another acquisition can be initiated. Following this delay, an input acquisition is automatically started on the selected channel. Note: bit 7 bit 0 10-bit A/D Result To enable the ADC module, the ADON bit of the ADCON0 register must be set to a ‘1’. Setting the GO/ DONE bit of the ADCON0 register to a ‘1’ will start the Analog-to-Digital conversion. Note: bit 0 ADC OPERATION DURING SLEEP The ADC module can operate during Sleep. This requires the ADC clock source to be set to the FRC option. When the FRC clock source is selected, the ADC waits one additional instruction before starting the conversion. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed, which can reduce system noise during the conversion. If the ADC interrupt is enabled, the device will wake-up from Sleep when the conversion completes. If the ADC interrupt is disabled, the ADC module is turned off after the conversion completes, although the ADON bit remains set. When the ADC clock source is something other than FRC, a SLEEP instruction causes the present conversion to be aborted and the ADC module is turned off, although the ADON bit remains set. 12.2.5 SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER The CCP Special Event Trigger allows periodic ADC measurements without software intervention. When this trigger occurs, the GO/DONE bit is set by hardware and the Timer1 counter resets to zero. Using the Special Event Trigger does not assure proper ADC timing. It is the user’s responsibility to ensure that the ADC timing requirements are met. See Section 10.0 “Capture/Compare/PWM Modules” for more information. A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state. Thus, the ADC module is turned off and any pending conversion is terminated. DS40001709A-page 116 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 12.2.6 A/D CONVERSION PROCEDURE EXAMPLE 12-1: This is an example procedure for using the ADC to perform an Analog-to-Digital conversion: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Configure Port: • Disable pin output driver (See TRIS register) • Configure pin as analog Configure the ADC module: • Select ADC conversion clock • Configure voltage reference • Select ADC input channel • Select result format • Turn on ADC module Configure ADC interrupt (optional): • Clear ADC interrupt flag • Enable ADC interrupt • Enable peripheral interrupt • Enable global interrupt(1) Wait the required acquisition time(2). Start conversion by setting the GO/DONE bit. Wait for ADC conversion to complete by one of the following: • Polling the GO/DONE bit • Waiting for the ADC interrupt (interrupts enabled) Read ADC Result Clear the ADC interrupt flag (required if interrupt is enabled). A/D CONVERSION ;This code block configures the ADC ;for polling, Vdd reference, Frc clock ;and RA0 input. ; ;Conversion start & polling for completion ; are included. ; BANKSEL TRISA ; BSF TRISA,0 ;Set RA0 to input BANKSEL ADCON1 ; MOVLW B’01110000’ ;ADC Frc clock, IORWF ADCON1 ; and RA0 as analog BANKSEL ADCON0 ; MOVLW B’10000001’ ;Right justify, MOVWF ADCON0 ;Vdd Vref, AN0, On CALL SampleTime ;Acquisiton delay BSF ADCON0,GO ;Start conversion TEST AGAIN BTFSC ADCON0,GO ;Is conversion done? GOTO TEST AGAIN ;No, test again BANKSEL ADRESH ; MOVF ADRESH,W ;Read upper 2 bits MOVWF RESULTHI ;Store in GPR space BANKSEL ADRESL ; MOVF ADRESL,W ;Read lower 8 bits MOVWF RESULTLO ;Store in GPR space Note 1: The global interrupt can be disabled if the user is attempting to wake-up from Sleep and resume in-line code execution. 2: See Section 12.4 “A/D Acquisition Requirements”. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 117 PIC16F753/HV753 12.3 Register Definitions: ADC Control REGISTER 12-1: ADCON0: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 0 R/W-0 U-0 ADFM — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CHS<3:0> R/W-0 R/W-0 GO/DONE ADON bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 ADFM: A/D Conversion Result Format Select bit 1 = Right justified 0 = Left justified bit 6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-2 CHS<3:0>: Analog Channel Select bits 0000 = AN0 0001 = AN1 0010 = AN2 0011 = AN3 0100 = AN4 0101 = AN5 0110 = AN6 0111 = AN7 1110 = DAC output 1111 = Fixed Voltage Reference bit 1 GO/DONE: A/D Conversion Status bit 1 = A/D conversion cycle in progress. Setting this bit starts an A/D conversion cycle. This bit is automatically cleared by hardware when the A/D conversion has completed. 0 = A/D conversion completed/not in progress bit 0 ADON: ADC Enable bit 1 = ADC is enabled 0 = ADC is disabled and consumes no operating current DS40001709A-page 118 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 12-2: U-0 ADCON1: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 1 R/W-0/0 — R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 ADCS<2:0> U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 — — — ADPREF1 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-4 ADCS<2:0>: A/D Conversion Clock Select bits 000 = FOSC/2 001 = FOSC/8 010 = FOSC/32 011 = FRC (clock supplied from an internal oscillator with a divisor of 16) 100 = FOSC/4 101 = FOSC/16 110 = FOSC/64 bit 3-1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 ADPREF1: ADC Positive Voltage Reference Selection bit 0 = VDD 1 = VREF+ 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 119 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 12-3: R-x ADRESH: ADC RESULT REGISTER HIGH (ADRESH) ADFM = 0 (READ-ONLY) R-x R-x R-x R-x R-x R-x R-x ADRESH<9:2> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown ADRESH<9:2>: ADC Result Register bits Upper eight bits of 10-bit conversion result bit 7-0 REGISTER 12-4: R-x ADRESL: ADC RESULT REGISTER LOW (ADRESL) ADFM = 0 (READ-ONLY) R-x U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 ADRESL<7:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 x = Bit is unknown ADRESL<7:0>: ADC Result Register bits Lower two bits of 10-bit conversion result REGISTER 12-5: ADRESH: ADC RESULT REGISTER HIGH (ADRESH) ADFM = 1 (READ-ONLY) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — R-x R-x ADRESH<9:8> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1-0 ADRESH<9:8>: ADC Result Register bits Upper two bits of 10-bit conversion result REGISTER 12-6: R-x x = Bit is unknown ADRESL: ADC RESULT REGISTER LOW (ADRESL) ADFM = 1 (READ-ONLY) R-x R-x R-x R-x R-x R-x R-x ADRESL<7:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 x = Bit is unknown ADRESL<7:0>: ADC Result Register bits Lower eight bits of 10-bit conversion result DS40001709A-page 120 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 12.4 A/D Acquisition Requirements For the ADC to meet its specified accuracy, the charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed to fully charge to the input channel voltage level. The Analog Input model is shown in Figure 12-4. The source impedance (RS) and the internal sampling switch (RSS) impedance directly affect the time required to charge the capacitor CHOLD. The sampling switch (RSS) impedance varies over the device voltage (VDD), see Figure 12-4. The maximum recommended impedance for analog sources is 10 k. As the source impedance is decreased, the acquisition time may be decreased. After the analog input channel is selected (or changed), EQUATION 12-1: an A/D acquisition must be done before the conversion can be started. To calculate the minimum acquisition time, Equation 12-1 may be used. This equation assumes that 1/2 LSb error is used (1024 steps for the ADC). The 1/2 LSb error is the maximum error allowed for the ADC to meet its specified resolution. ACQUISITION TIME EXAMPLE Temperature = 50°C and external impedance of 10k 5.0V V DD Assumptions: T ACQ = Amplifier Settling Time + Hold Capacitor Charging Time + Temperature Coefficient = T AMP + T C + T COFF = 2µs + T C + Temperature - 25°C 0.05µs/°C The value for TC can be approximated with the following equations: 1 V AP PLIE D 1 – ------------ = V CHOLD 2047 ;[1] VCHOLD charged to within 1/2 lsb –TC ---------- RC V AP P LI ED 1 – e = V CHOLD ;[2] VCHOLD charge response to VAPPLIED – Tc --------- 1 RC V AP P LIED 1 – e = V A P PLIE D 1 – ------------ 2047 ;combining [1] and [2] Solving for TC: T C = – C HOLD R IC + R SS + R S ln(1/2047) = – 10pF 1k + 7k + 10k ln(0.0004885) = 1.37 µs Therefore: T ACQ = 2µs + 1.37µs + 50°C- 25°C 0.05µs/°C = 4.67µs Note 1: The reference voltage (VREF) has no effect on the equation, since it cancels itself out. 2: The charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) is not discharged after each conversion. 3: The maximum recommended impedance for analog sources is 10 k. This is required to meet the pin leakage specification. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 121 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 12-4: ANALOG INPUT MODEL VDD ANx RS CPIN 5 pF VA VT = 0.6V Vt = 0.6V Ric 1k Sampling Switch SS Rss ILEAKAGE ± 500 nA CHOLD = 10 pF VSS/VREF- Legend: CPIN = Input Capacitance VT = Threshold Voltage ILEAKAGE = Leakage current at the pin due to various junctions = Interconnect Resistance RIC = Sampling Switch SS = Sample/Hold Capacitance CHOLD FIGURE 12-5: 6V 5V VDD 4V 3V 2V RSS 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Sampling Switch (k) ADC TRANSFER FUNCTION Full-Scale Range 3FFh 3FEh ADC Output Code 3FDh 3FCh 1 LSB ideal 3FBh Full-Scale Transition 004h 003h 002h 001h 000h Analog Input Voltage 1 LSB ideal VSS/VREF- DS40001709A-page 122 Zero-Scale Transition Preliminary VDD/VREF+ 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 12-2: Name SUMMARY OF ASSOCIATED ADC REGISTERS Bit 7 Bit 6 ADCON0 ADFM — ADCON1 — ANSELA — ADRESH(2) Bit 4 — Bit 3 Bit 2 CHS<3:0> ADCS<2:0> — ANSA4 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page GO/DONE ADON 118 — — — ADPREF1 119 — ANSA2 ANSA1 ANSA0 48 Most Significant eight bits of the left shifted A/D result or two bits of the right shifted result 120* Least Significant two bits of the left shifted result or eight bits of the right shifted result 118* ADRESL(2) PORTA Bit 5 — — RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 46 GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF 19 PIE1 TMR1GIE ADIE — — HLTMR2IE HLTMR1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 20 PIR1 TMR1GIF ADIF — — HLTMR2IF HLTMR1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF 22 — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3(1) TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 46 INTCON TRISA Legend: * Note 1: 2: x = unknown, u = unchanged, — = unimplemented read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for ADC module. Page provides register information. TRISA3 always reads ‘1’. Read-only register. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 123 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 124 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 13.0 FIXED VOLTAGE REFERENCE (FVR) 13.2 When the Fixed Voltage Reference module is enabled, it requires time for the reference circuit to stabilize. Once the circuit stabilizes and is ready for use, the FVRRDY bit of the FVRCON register will be set. See Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications” for the minimum delay requirement. The Fixed Voltage Reference (FVR) is a stable voltage reference, independent of VDD, with 1.2V output level. The output of the FVR can be configured to supply a reference voltage to the following: • • • • • ADC input channel Comparator 1 positive input (C1VP) Comparator 2 positive input (C2VP) REFOUT pin Shunt regulator 13.3 Operation During Sleep When the device wakes up from Sleep through an interrupt or a Watchdog Timer time-out, the contents of the FVRCON register are not affected. To minimize current consumption in Sleep mode, the FVR voltage reference should be disabled. On the PIC16F753, the FVR is enabled by setting the FVREN bit of the FVRCON register. The FVR is always enabled on the PIC16HV753 device. 13.1 FVR Stabilization Period 13.4 Fixed Voltage Reference Output Effects of a Reset A device Reset clears the FVRCON register. As a result: The FVR output can be applied to the REFOUT pin by setting the FVRBUFSS and FVRBUFEN bits of the FVRCON register. The FVRBUFSS bit selects the op amp, FVR or DAC output reference to the REFOUT pin buffer. The FVRBUFEN bit enables the output buffer to the REFOUT pin. • The FVR module is disabled • The FVR voltage output is disabled on the REFOUT pin Enabling the REFOUT pin automatically overrides any digital input or output functions of the pin. Reading the REFOUT pin when it has been configured for a reference voltage output will always return a ‘0’. FIGURE 13-1: VOLTAGE REFERENCE BLOCK DIAGRAM FVR_ref FVR_buffer VDD 1.2V DAC_out 01 OPA_out 10 FVRIN 11 FVREN(1) To Peripherals FVROE 00 + To Peripherals x1 FVR_out FVRBUFEN rdy EN VSS FVRRDY FVRBUFSS Note 1: If using PIC16HV753, the FVR will be enabled. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 125 PIC16F753/HV753 13.5 Register Definitions: FVR Control REGISTER 13-1: FVR1CON0: FIXED VOLTAGE REFERENCE CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0/0 R-q/q R/W-0/0 FVREN FVRRDY FVROE R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 FVRBUFSS1 FVRBUFSS0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 — — FVRBUFEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = Value depends on condition bit 7 FVREN: Fixed Voltage Reference Enable bit 0 = Fixed Voltage Reference is disabled 1 = Fixed Voltage Reference is enabled bit 6 FVRRDY: Fixed Voltage Reference Ready Flag bit 0 = Fixed Voltage Reference output is not ready or not enabled bit 1 = Fixed Voltage Reference output is ready for use bit 5 FVROE: Voltage Reference Output Pin Buffer Enable bit 0 = Output pass gate is disabled 1 = Output pass gate is enabled bit 4-3 FVRBUFSS<1:0>: Voltage Reference Pin Buffer Source Select bits 00 = Selects the output of the band gap as the input 01 = DAC output 10 = Op amp buffered output 11 = Selects FVRIN (RA1) bit 2-1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 FVRBUFEN: Voltage Reference Output Pin Buffer Enable bit 0 = Output buffer is disabled 1 = Output buffer is enabled TABLE 13-1: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH FIXED VOLTAGE REFERENCE Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page FVR1CON0 FVREN FVRRDY FVROE FVRBUFSS1 FVRBUFSS0 — — FVRBUFEN 126 Legend: Shaded cells are not used with the Fixed Voltage Reference. DS40001709A-page 126 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 14.0 DIGITAL-TO-ANALOG CONVERTER (DAC) MODULE The Digital-to-Analog Converter supplies a variable voltage reference, ratiometric with the input source, with 512 selectable output levels. 14.1 Output Voltage Selection The DAC has 512 voltage level ranges. The 512 levels are set with the DACR<8:1> bits of the DACxREFH register and DACR0 of the DACxREFL. The DAC output voltage is determined by Equation 14-1: The input of the DAC can be connected to: • External VREF pins • VDD supply voltage • FVR (Fixed Voltage Reference) The output of the DAC can be configured to supply a reference voltage to the following: • • • • Comparator positive input ADC input channel DACXOUT pin Op amp The Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) is enabled by setting the DACEN bit of the DACxCON0 register. EQUATION 14-1: DAC OUTPUT VOLTAGE IF DACEN = 1 DACR 8 VOUT = VSOURCE+ – VSOURCE- -----------------------+ VSOURCE9 2 VSOURCE+ = VDD, VREF, OPA1OUTor FVR BUFFER 2 VSOURCE- = VSS 14.2 Ratiometric Output Level 14.4 The DAC output value is derived using a resistor ladder with each end of the ladder tied to a positive and negative voltage reference input source. If the voltage of either input source fluctuates, a similar fluctuation will result in the DAC output value. The value of the individual resistors within the ladder can be found in Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications”. 14.3 DAC Justification The DAC can be configured to be left or right justified based on application needs. In order for justification to work properly, all 16 bits of the DAC buffer register (DACxREFH:DACxREFL register pair) must be loaded in the correct sequence to get the effective 9-bit result. In most applications, DACxREFL is written prior to DACxREFH, regardless of justification. The DAC buffer is loaded at the end of the write cycle that writes DACxREFH register. DAC Voltage Reference Output The DAC voltage can be output to the DACxOUT pins by setting the DACOE1 bit of the DACxCON0 register. Selecting the DAC reference voltage for output on the DACXOUT pin automatically overrides the digital output buffer and digital input threshold detector functions of that pin. Reading the DACXOUT pin when it has been configured for DAC reference voltage output will always return a ‘0’. Due to the limited current drive capability, a buffer must be used on the DAC voltage reference output for external connections to either DACXOUT pin. Figure 14-2 shows a buffering technique example. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 127 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 14-1: DIGITAL-TO-ANALOG CONVERTER BLOCK DIAGRAM Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) 9-bit Latch (not visible to user) OPA1_out FVR_buffer2 DACxREFH DACxREFL VSOURCE+ write to DACxREFH VDD VREF+ DACPSS<1:0> R 9 R 2 DACEN R 512 Steps R 512-to-1 MUX R DAC_output To Peripherals DACxOUT1 R DACOE1 R VSOURCE- VSS FIGURE 14-2: VOLTAGE REFERENCE OUTPUT BUFFER EXAMPLE PIC® MCU DAC Module R Voltage Reference Output Impedance DS40001709A-page 128 DACXOUT Preliminary + – Buffered DAC Output 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 14.5 Operation During Sleep When the device wakes up from Sleep through an interrupt or a Watchdog Timer time-out, the contents of the DACxCON0 register are not affected. To minimize current consumption in Sleep mode, the voltage reference should be disabled. 14.6 Effects of a Reset A device Reset affects the following: • DAC is disabled • DAC output voltage is removed from the DACXOUT pin • The DACR<8:0> range select bits are cleared 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 129 PIC16F753/HV753 14.7 Register Definitions: DAC Control REGISTER 14-1: DACxCON0: VOLTAGE REFERENCE CONTROL REGISTER 0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 U-0 DACEN DACFM DACOE — R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 U-0 U-0 — — DACPSS<1:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 DACEN: DAC Enable bit 1 = DACx is enabled 0 = DACx is disabled bit 6 DACFM: DAC Output Format bit 1 = DACx output result is right justified 0 = DACx output result is left justified bit 5 DACOE: DAC Voltage Output Enable bit 1 = DACx voltage level is also an output on the DACxOUT pin 0 = DACx voltage level is disconnected from the DACxOUT pin bit 4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-2 DACPSS<1:0>: DAC Positive Source Select bits 11 = FVR output 10 = VREF+ pin 01 = OPA1OUT pin 00 = VDD bit 1-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DS40001709A-page 130 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 14-2: R/W-0/0 DACxREFH: DAC REFERENCE HIGH REGISTER (DACxFM = 0) R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 DACR<8:1> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 DACR<8:1>: DAC Reference Selection bits DACxOUT = (DACR<8:0> x (Vdac_ref)/512) REGISTER 14-3: DACxREFL: DAC REFERENCE LOW REGISTER (DACxFM = 0) R/W-0/0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 DACR0 — — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 DACR0: DAC Reference Selection bits DACxOUT = (DACR<8:0> x (Vdac_ref)/512) bit 6-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 131 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 14-4: DACxREFH: DAC REFERENCE HIGH REGISTER (DACxFM = 1) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 — — — — — — — DACR8 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 DACR8: DAC Reference Selection bits DACxOUT = (DACR<8:0> x (Vdac_ref) / 512) REGISTER 14-5: R/W-0/0 DACxREFL: DAC REFERENCE LOW REGISTER (DACxFM = 1) R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 DACR<7:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-0 DACR<7:0>: DAC Reference Selection bits DACxOUT = (DACR<8:0> x (Vdac_ref) / 512) TABLE 14-1: Name DACxCON0 SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE DAC MODULE Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 DACEN DACFM DACOE — DACxREFH DACxREFH Legend: Bit 2 DACPSS<1:0> Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page — — 130 DACR<8:1> — — — DACxREFL DACxREFL Bit 3 — — 131 — — DACR8 — — — DACR<7:0> DACR0 — — — — 132 131 132 — = Unimplemented location, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used with the DAC module. DS40001709A-page 132 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 15.0 COMPARATOR MODULE FIGURE 15-1: Comparators are used to interface analog circuits to a digital circuit by comparing two analog voltages and providing a digital indication of their relative magnitudes. Comparators are very useful mixed-signal building blocks because they provide analog functionality independent of program execution. The analog comparator module includes the following features: • • • • • • • • • Independent comparator control Programmable input selection Comparator output is available internally/externally Programmable output polarity Interrupt-on-change Wake-up from Sleep Programmable Speed/Power optimization PWM shutdown Programmable and Fixed Voltage Reference 15.1 SINGLE COMPARATOR VIN+ + VIN- – Output VINVIN+ Output Note: Comparator Overview The black areas of the output of the comparator represents the uncertainty due to input offsets and response time. A single comparator is shown in Figure 15-1 along with the relationship between the analog input levels and the digital output. When the analog voltage at VIN+ is less than the analog voltage at VIN-, the output of the comparator is a digital low level. When the analog voltage at VIN+ is greater than the analog voltage at VIN-, the output of the comparator is a digital high level. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 133 COMPARATOR MODULE SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM CxNCH[1:0] CxON(1) 2 CXIN0- 0 CXIN1- 1 CXIN2- 2 CXIN3- 3 Slope Compensator 4-7 det CxVN CxVP DAC_OUT Preliminary 2 Slope Compensator 3 CXPOL - 0 + Zero Latency Filter D D Q CXOUT MCOUTX Q 1 CxHYS To COG Module, Slope test output icd_freeze CXSYNC 4-7 CxON AGND To Data Bus EN Q1 EN 0 MUX 1 (2) FVR Reference det CXZLF CxSP Set CxIF CxINTN Interrupt Cx CXIN+ CxINTP Interrupt 0 D CXPCH[2:0] 3 Note 1: When CxON = 0, the Comparator will produce a ‘0’ at the output. 2: When CxON = 0, all multiplexer inputs are disconnected. From Timer1 tmr1_clk Q CXOE TRIS bit CXOUT 1 To Timer1 SYNCCXOUT PIC16F753/HV753 DS40001709A-page 134 FIGURE 15-2: 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 15.2 Comparator Control 15.2.3 Each comparator has two control registers: CMxCON0 and CMxCON1. The CMxCON0 registers (see Register 15-1) contain Control and Status bits for the following: • • • • • • • Enable Output selection Output pin enable Output polarity Speed/Power selection Hysteresis enable Output synchronization Inverting the output of the comparator is functionally equivalent to swapping the comparator inputs. The polarity of the comparator output can be inverted by setting the CxPOL bit of the CMxCON0 register. Clearing the CxPOL bit results in a non-inverted output. Table 15-1 shows the output state versus input conditions, including polarity control. TABLE 15-1: • Interrupt edge polarity (rising and/or falling) • Positive input channel selection • Negative input channel selection CxPOL CxOUT CxVN > CxVP 0 0 CxVN < CxVP 0 1 CxVN > CxVP 1 1 CxVN < CxVP 1 0 15.2.4 COMPARATOR ENABLE Setting the CxON bit of the CMxCON0 register enables the comparator for operation. Clearing the CxON bit disables the comparator resulting in minimum current consumption. 15.2.2 COMPARATOR OUTPUT SELECTION The output of the comparator can be monitored by reading either the CxOUT bit of the CMxCON0 register or the MCOUTx bit of the CMOUT register. In order to make the output available for an external connection, the following conditions must be true: • CxOE bit of the CMxCON0 register must be set • Corresponding TRIS bit must be cleared • CxON bit of the CMxCON0 register must be set COMPARATOR SPEED/POWER SELECTION The trade-off between speed or power can be optimized during program execution with the CxSP control bit. The default state for this bit is ‘1’ which selects the normal speed mode. Device power consumption can be optimized at the cost of slower comparator propagation delay by clearing the CxSP bit to ‘0’. 15.3 Comparator Hysteresis A selectable amount of separation voltage can be added to the input pins of each comparator to provide a hysteresis function to the overall operation. Hysteresis is enabled by setting the CxHYS bit of the CMxCON0 register. See Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications” for more information. Note 1: The CxOE bit of the CMxCON0 register overrides the PORT data latch. Setting the CxON bit of the CMxCON0 register has no impact on the port override. 2: The internal output of the comparator is latched with each instruction cycle. Unless otherwise specified, external outputs are not latched. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. COMPARATOR OUTPUT STATE VS. INPUT CONDITIONS Input Condition The CMxCON1 registers (see Register 15-2) contain Control bits for the following: 15.2.1 COMPARATOR OUTPUT POLARITY 15.4 Timer1 Gate Operation The output resulting from a comparator operation can be used as a source for gate control of Timer1. See Section 7.5 “Timer1 Gate” for more information. This feature is useful for timing the duration or interval of an analog event. It is recommended that the comparator output be synchronized to Timer1. This ensures that Timer1 does not increment while a change in the comparator is occurring. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 135 PIC16F753/HV753 15.4.1 15.6 COMPARATOR OUTPUT SYNCHRONIZATION Comparator Positive Input Selection The output from either comparator, C1 or C2, can be synchronized with Timer1 by setting the CxSYNC bit of the CMxCON0 register. Configuring the CxPCH<1:0> bits of the CMxCON1 register directs an internal voltage reference or an analog pin to the non-inverting input of the comparator: Once enabled, the comparator output is latched on the falling edge of the Timer1 source clock. If a prescaler is used with Timer1, the comparator output is latched after the prescaling function. To prevent a race condition, the comparator output is latched on the falling edge of the Timer1 clock source and Timer1 increments on the rising edge of its clock source. See the Comparator Block Diagram (Figure 15-2) and the Timer1 Block Diagram (Figure 7-1) for more information. • • • • 15.5 Comparator Interrupt An interrupt can be generated upon a change in the output value of the comparator for each comparator, a rising edge detector and a falling edge detector are present. When either edge detector is triggered and its associated enable bit is set (CxINTP and/or CxINTN bits of the CMxCON1 register), the Corresponding Interrupt Flag bit (CxIF bit of the PIR2 register) will be set. CxIN0+ analog pin DAC Reference Voltage (dac_ref) FVR Reference Voltage (fvr_ref) VSS (Ground) See Section 13.0 “Fixed Voltage Reference (FVR)” for more information on the Fixed Voltage Reference module. See Section 14.0 “Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Module” for more information on the DAC input signal. Any time the comparator is disabled (CxON = 0), all comparator inputs are disabled. 15.7 The CxNCH0 bit of the CMxCON0 register selects the analog input pin to the comparator inverting input. Note: To enable the interrupt, you must set the following bits: • CxON, CxPOL and CxSP bits of the CMxCON0 register • CxIE bit of the PIE2 register • CxINTP bit of the CMxCON1 register (for a rising edge detection) • CxINTN bit of the CMxCON1 register (for a falling edge detection) • PEIE and GIE bits of the INTCON register The associated interrupt flag bit, CxIF bit of the PIR2 register, must be cleared in software. If another edge is detected while this flag is being cleared, the flag will still be set at the end of the sequence. Note: Although a comparator is disabled, an interrupt can be generated by changing the output polarity with the CxPOL bit of the CMxCON0 register, or by switching the comparator on or off with the CxON bit of the CMxCON0 register. DS40001709A-page 136 Comparator Negative Input Selection 15.8 To use CxIN0+ and CxIN1x- pins as analog input, the appropriate bits must be set in the ANSEL register and the corresponding TRIS bits must also be set to disable the output drivers. Comparator Response Time The comparator output is indeterminate for a period of time after the change of an input source or the selection of a new reference voltage. This period is referred to as the response time. The response time of the comparator differs from the settling time of the voltage reference. Therefore, both of these times must be considered when determining the total response time to a comparator input change. See the Comparator and Voltage Reference Specifications in Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications” for more details. 15.9 Interaction with the COG Module The comparator outputs can be brought to the COG module in order to facilitate auto-shutdown. If autorestart is also enabled, the comparators can be configured as a closed loop analog feedback to the COG, thereby creating an analog controlled PWM. Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 15.10 Zero Latency Filter In high-speed operation, and under proper circuit conditions, it is possible for the comparator output to oscillate. This oscillation can have adverse effects on the hardware and software relying on this signal. Therefore, a digital filter has been added to the comparator output to suppress the comparator output oscillation. Once the comparator output changes, the output is prevented from reversing the change for a nominal time of 20 ns. This allows the comparator output to stabilize without affecting other dependent devices. Refer to Figure 15-3. FIGURE 15-3: COMPARATOR ZERO LATENCY FILTER OPERATION CxOUT From Comparator CxOUT From ZLF TZLF Output waiting for TZLF to expire before an output change is allowed TZLF has expired so output change of ZLF is immediate based on comparator output change 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 137 PIC16F753/HV753 15.11 Analog Input Connection Considerations A simplified circuit for an analog input is shown in Figure 15-4. Since the analog input pins share their connection with a digital input, they have reverse biased ESD protection diodes to VDD and VSS. The analog input, therefore, must be between VSS and VDD. If the input voltage deviates from this range by more than 0.6V in either direction, one of the diodes is forward biased and a latch-up may occur. Note 1: When reading a PORT register, all pins configured as analog inputs will read as a ‘0’. Pins configured as digital inputs will convert as an analog input, according to the input specification. 2: Analog levels on any pin defined as a digital input, may cause the input buffer to consume more current than is specified. A maximum source impedance of 10 k is recommended for the analog sources. Also, any external component connected to an analog input pin, such as a capacitor or a Zener diode, should have very little leakage current to minimize inaccuracies introduced. FIGURE 15-4: ANALOG INPUT MODEL VDD Rs < 10K Analog Input pin VT 0.6V RIC To Comparator VA CPIN 5 pF VT 0.6V ILEAKAGE(1) Vss Legend: CPIN = Input Capacitance ILEAKAGE = Leakage Current at the pin due to various junctions = Interconnect Resistance RIC RS = Source Impedance = Analog Voltage VA = Threshold Voltage VT Note 1: DS40001709A-page 138 See Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications”. Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 15.12 Register Definitions: Comparator Control REGISTER 15-1: CMxCON0: COMPARATOR Cx CONTROL REGISTER 0 R/W-0/0 R-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-1/1 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 CxON CxOUT CxOE CxPOL CxZLF CxSP CxHYS CxSYNC bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 CxON: Comparator Enable bit 1 = Comparator is enabled 0 = Comparator is disabled and consumes no active power bit 6 CxOUT: Comparator Output bit If CxPOL = 1 (inverted polarity): 1 = CxVP < CxVN 0 = CxVP > CxVN If CxPOL = 0 (non-inverted polarity): 1 = CxVP > CxVN 0 = CxVP < CxVN bit 5 CxOE: Comparator Output Enable bit 1 = CxOUT is present on the CxOUT pin. Requires that the associated TRIS bit be cleared to actually drive the pin. Not affected by CxON. 0 = CxOUT is internal only bit 4 CxPOL: Comparator Output Polarity Select bit 1 = Comparator output is inverted 0 = Comparator output is not inverted bit 3 CxZLF: Zero Latency Filter Enable bit 1 = Zero latency filter is enabled 0 = Zero latency filter is disabled bit 2 CxSP: Comparator Speed/Power Select bit 1 = Comparator operates in normal power, higher speed mode 0 = Comparator operates in low-power, low-speed mode bit 1 CxHYS: Comparator Hysteresis Enable bit 1 = Comparator hysteresis enabled 0 = Comparator hysteresis disabled bit 0 CxSYNC: Comparator Output Synchronous Mode bit 1 = Comparator output to Timer1 and I/O pin is synchronous to changes on Timer1 clock source. Output updated on the falling edge of Timer1 clock source. 0 = Comparator output to Timer1 and I/O pin is asynchronous. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 139 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 15-2: CMxCON1: COMPARATOR Cx CONTROL REGISTER 1 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 CxINTP CxINTN R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 CxPCH<1:0> R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 CxNCH<2:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7 CxINTP: Comparator Interrupt on Positive Going Edge Enable bit 1 = The CxIF interrupt flag will be set upon a positive going edge of the CxOUT bit 0 = No interrupt flag will be set on a positive going edge of the CxOUT bit bit 6 CxINTN: Comparator Interrupt on Negative Going Edge Enable bit 1 = The CxIF interrupt flag will be set upon a negative going edge of the CxOUT bit 0 = No interrupt flag will be set on a negative going edge of the CxOUT bit bit 5-3 CxPCH<1:0>: Comparator Positive Input Channel Select bits 000 = CxVP connects to CxIN+ pin 001 = CxVP connects to dac_out 010 = CxVP connects to FVR 011 = CxVP connects to Slope Compensator Output 1xx = CxVP connects to AGND bit 2-0 CxNCH<2:0>: Comparator Negative Input Channel Select bits 000 = CxVN connects to CxIN0- pin 001 = CxVN connects to CxIN1- pin 010 = CxVN connects to CxIN2- pin 011 = CxVN connects to CxIN3- pin 1xx = CxVN connects to Slope Compensator Output REGISTER 15-3: CMOUT: COMPARATOR OUTPUT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R-0/0 R-0/0 — — — — — — MCOUT2 MCOUT1 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 7-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 MCOUT2: Mirror Copy of C2OUT bit bit 0 MCOUT1: Mirror Copy of C1OUT bit DS40001709A-page 140 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 15-2: Name SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH COMPARATOR MODULE Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 C1OE Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 C1POL C1ZLF C1SP CM1CON0 C1ON C1OUT CM1CON1 C1INTP C1INTN CM2CON0 C2ON C2OUT CM2CON1 C2INTP C2INTN — — — — — — DACEN DACFM DACOE — DACPSS1 DACPSS0 CMOUT DAC1CON0 Register on Page C1HYS C1SYNC 139 C2ZLF C2SP C2HYS 140 C2SYNC 139 MCOUT2 MCOUT1 140 — — 130 FVRBUFEN 126 C2NCH<2:0> C2PCH<2:0> 140 Least Significant bit of the left shifted result or eight bits of the right shifted DAC setting DAC1REFL FVR1CON0 C2POL Bit 0 C1NCH<2:0> C1PCH<2:0> C2OE Bit 1 FVREN FVRRDY FVROE FVRBUFSS1 FVRBUFSS0 — — 132 GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF 19 PIE2 — — C2IE C1IE — COG1IE — CCP1IE 21 PIR2 — — C2IF C1IF — COG1IF — CCP1IF 23 TRISA — — TRISA5 TRISA4 TRISA3(1) TRISA2 TRISA1 TRISA0 46 — — — ANSA4 — ANSA2 ANSA1 ANSA0 48 INTCON ANSELA Legend: Note 1: — = unimplemented location, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are unused by the comparator module. TRISA3 always reads ‘1’. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 141 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 142 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 16.0 OPERATIONAL AMPLIFIER (OPA) MODULE 16.3 Common AC and DC performance specifications for the OPA module: The Operational Amplifier (OPA) is a standard threeterminal device requiring external feedback to operate. The OPA module has the following features: • • • • • • • • • External Connections to I/O Ports Selectable Unity Gain Bandwidth Product Option Low Leakage Inputs Factory Calibrated Input Offset Voltage 16.1 OPAxCON0 Register The OPA module is enabled by setting the OPAxEN bit of the OPAxCON register. When enabled, the OPA forces the output driver of the OPAxOUT pin into tristate to prevent contention between the driver and the OPA output. Leakage current is a measure of the small source or sink currents on the OPAx+ and OPAx- inputs. To minimize the effect of leakage currents, the effective impedances connected to the OPAx+ and OPAx- inputs should be kept as small as possible and equal. Input offset voltage is a measure of the voltage difference between the OPAx+ and OPAx- inputs in a closed loop circuit with the OPA in its linear region. The offset voltage will appear as a DC offset in the output equal to the input offset voltage, multiplied by the gain of the circuit. The OPAxUGM bit of the OPAxCON register enables the Unity Gain Bandwidth mode (voltage follower) of the amplifier. In Unity Gain mode, the OPAxNCH<1:0> inputs are disabled. The default mode is normal threeterminal operation. 16.2 When the OPA module is enabled, the OPAxOUT pin is driven by the op amp output, not by the PORT digital driver. Refer to Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications” for the op amp output drive capability. The input offset voltage is also affected by the Common mode voltage. The OPA is factory-calibrated to minimize the input offset voltage of the module. Open loop gain is the ratio of the output voltage to the differential input voltage (OPAx+) - (OPAx-). The gain is greatest at DC and falls off with frequency. Gain Bandwidth Product or GBWP is the frequency at which the open loop gain falls off to 0 dB. The lower GBWP is optimized for systems requiring low-frequency response and low-power consumption. Effects of a Reset A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state. This disables the OPA module. FIGURE 16-1: Common Mode Voltage Range Leakage Current Input Offset Voltage Open Loop Gain Gain Bandwidth Product Common mode voltage range is the specified voltage range for the OPAx+ and OPAx- inputs, for which the OPA module will perform within its specifications. The OPA module is designed to operate with input voltages between VSS and VDD. Behavior for Common mode voltages greater than VDD or below VSS is not guaranteed. The OPAxCON0 register, shown in Register 16-1, controls the OPA module. Note: OPA Module Performance OPA MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM OPAxNCH<1:0> FVR_buffer1 11 DACx_output 10 01 OPAxIN- 1 0 00 OPAxUGM OPAx- OPAx+ FVR_buffer1 11 DACx_output 10 SLOPE_output 01 OPAxIN+ 00 OPAxOUT OPAx + OPAx_output OPAxEN OPAxPCH<1:0> 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 143 PIC16F753/HV753 16.4 Register Definitions: OPA Control REGISTER 16-1: OPAxCON0: OP AMP CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0/0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 OPAxEN — — OPAxUGM R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 OPAxNCH<1:0> R/W-0/0 OPAxPCH<1:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 7 OPAxEN: OPAx Enable bit 1 = OPAx is enabled 0 = OPAx is disabled bit 6-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 OPAxUGM: OPAx Unity Gain Mode Enable bit 1 = OPAx is in Unity gain mode 0 = OPAx is not in Unity gain mode - operates as a three-terminal op amp bit 3-2 OPAxNCH<1:0>: OPAx Negative Input Source Selection bit 11 = OPAx- connects to FVR_buffer1 10 = OPAx- connects to DAC1_output 0x = OPAx- connects to OPAxIN- pin bit 1-0 OPAxPCH<1:0>: OPAx Positive Input Source Selection bit 11 = OPAx+ connects to FVR_buffer1 10 = OPAx+ connects to DAC1_output 01 = OPAx+ connects to SLOPE_output 00 = OPAx+ connects to OPAxIN+ pin TABLE 16-1: Name REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE OPA MODULE Bit 7 OPA1CON0 OPA1EN TRISC ANSELC Legend: Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 OPA1NCH<1:0> Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page — — OPA1UGM — — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3 TRISC2 TRISC1 OPA1PCH<1:0> TRISC0 144 52 — — — — ANSC3 ANSC2 ANSC1 ANSC0 54 x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for the OPA module. DS40001709A-page 144 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 17.0 SLOPE COMPENSATION (SC) MODULE 17.1 Theory of Operation The SC module works by quickly discharging an internal capacitor at the beginning of each PWM period. A internal current sink charges this capacitor at a programmable rate. As the capacitor charges, the capacitor voltage is subtracted from the reference voltage, producing a linear voltage decay at the required rate. The current reference voltage can be supplied by either an I/O pin or by the buffered output of the FVR peripheral. The FVR module provides either a fixed voltage or a programmable DAC output. The Reset source can be derived from either COG output or the synchronized output of either comparator. Additionally, the Reset source can be inverted before triggering the Reset. The slope voltage can be sent to either comparator or the op amp. The Slope Compensation (SC) module is designed to provide the necessary slope compensation for fixed frequency, continuous current, current mode switched power supplies. Slope compensation is a necessary feature of these power supplies because it prevents frequency instabilities at duty cycles greater than 50%. The core of the SC module is: • an on-chip capacitor in series with the voltage source, • a shorting switch across the capacitor, and • a calibrated current sink. A one-shot pulse generator ensures that the switch is closed long enough to completely discharge the capacitor. This typically takes 50 nS. FIGURE 17-1: SIMPLIFIED SC MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM SCxINS SLPCIN 0 FVR_buffer1 1 SLOPE_output to peripherals SCxPOL COG1_output0 00 COG1_output1 01 C1OUT_sync 10 C2OUT_sync 11 One Shot SCxTSS<1:0> SCxISET * 0.75/15 + 0.2V/µS SCxISET<3:0> 1 0 SCxISET + 1.0V/µS SCxRNG 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 145 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 17-2: SLOPE COMPENSATION TIMING DIAGRAM Slope Compensation Trigger COG or Comparator Output One Shot Output Slope Compensation Reference Voltage Slope Compensation Output 17.2 Using the SC Module The slope compensator input reference voltage should be set to the target circuit peak current sense voltage. The slope compensator output voltage starts at the input reference voltage and should fall at a rate less than half the target circuit current sense voltage rate of rise. Therefore, the compensator slope expressed as volts per µs can be computed as shown in Equation 17-2. For example, when the circuit is using a 1 current sense resistor and the peak current is 1A, then the peak current expressed as a voltage (VREF) is 1V. If your power supply is running at 1 MHz, then the period is 1 s. Therefore, the desired slope is: EQUATION 17-2: 1 V REF --------------2 2 -------------------------------------------- = --------- = 0.5V s 1s PWM Period ( s EQUATION 17-1: V REF ------------V 2 ------ ------------------------------------------- s PWM Period ( s DS40001709A-page 146 Note: The setting for 0.5V/s is SCxISET<3:0> = 6 and SCxRNG = 0. Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 17-3: EXAMPLE SLOPE COMPENSATION CIRCUIT VIN L1 D1 COGxOUTx C1 COG + R2 CxINxR1 SC SLPCIN DAC OPAxOUT OPAxIN- + R4 R3 - C2 R5 C3 17.3 Inputs The SC module connects to the following inputs: • • • • COG1 COG2 Comparator C1 Comparator C2 17.4 Outputs The SC module connects to the following outputs: • Comparator C1 • Comparator C2 • Op amp 17.5 Operation During Sleep The SC module is unaffected by Sleep. 17.6 Effects of a Reset The SC module resets to a disabled condition. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 147 PIC16F753/HV753 17.7 Register Definitions: Slope Compensation Control REGISTER 17-1: SLPCCON0: SLOPE COMPENSATION CONTROL 0 REGISTER R/W-0/0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 SCxEN — — SCxPOL R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 U-0 R/W-0/0 — SCxINS SCxTSS<1:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = value depends on configuration bits bit 7 SCxEN: Slope Compensation Enable bit 1 = Slope compensation is enabled 0 = Slope compensation is disabled bit 6-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 SCxPOL: Slope Compensation Input Polarity bit 1 = Signal is inverted polarity (active-low) 0 = Signal is normal polarity (active-high) bit 3-2 SCxTSS<1:0>: Slope Compensation Timing Select bits 11 = C2OUT_sync 10 = C1OUT_sync 01 = COG1_output1 00 = COG1_output0 bit 1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 SCxINS: Slope Compensation Input Select bit 1 = FVR_buffer1 is selected 0 = SLPC1IN pin is selected REGISTER 17-2: SLPCCON1: SLOPE COMPENSATION CONTROL 1 REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0/0 — — — SCxRNG R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 R/W-0/0 SCxISET<3:0> bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ u = Bit is unchanged x = Bit is unknown -n/n = Value at POR and BOR/Value at all other Resets ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared q = value depends on configuration bits bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 SCxRNG: Slope Compensator Range bit 1 = Range setting is SCxISET * 0.75/15 +0.2V/s 0 = Range setting is SCxISET +1.0V/s bit 3-0 SCxISET<3:0>: Slope Compensator Current Sink Set bits xxxxx = SC module Slope Selection DS40001709A-page 148 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 17-1: SLOPE COMPENSATOR CURRENT SETTINGS SC1ISET Value Current Setting (uA) Slope Value (V/us) SC1ISET Value Current Setting (uA) Slope Value (V/us) 0h 2 0.2 10h 10 1.0 1h 2.5 0.25 11h 11 1.1 2h 3 0.3 12h 12 1.2 3h 3.5 0.35 13h 13 1.3 4h 4 0.4 14h 14 1.4 5h 4.5 0.45 15h 15 1.5 6h 5 0.5 16h 16 1.6 7h 5.5 0.55 17h 17 1.7 8h 6 0.6 18h 18 1.8 9h 6.5 0.65 19h 19 1.9 Ah 7 0.7 1Ah 20 2.0 Bh 7.5 0.75 1Bh 21 2.1 Ch 8 0.8 1Ch 22 2.2 Dh 8.5 0.85 1Dh 23 2.3 Eh 9 0.9 1Eh 24 2.4 Fh 9.5 0.95 1Fh 25 2.5 TABLE 17-2: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE SC MODULE Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page SLPCCON0 SC1EN — — SC1POL SC1TSS1 SC1TSS0 — SC1INS 148 SLPCCON1 — — — SC1RNG PORTC — — RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 51 TRISC — — TRISC5 TRISC4 TRISC3 TRISC2 TRISC1 TRISC0 52 ANSELC — — — — ANSC3 ANSC2 ANSC1 ANSC0 54 — — WPUC5 WPUC4 WPUC3 WPUC2 WPUC1 WPUC0 55 WPUC Legend: CONFIG SUMMARY OF CONFIGURATION WORD WITH THE SLOPE COMPENSATOR Bits Bit -/7 Bit -/6 Bit 13/5 Bit 12/4 13:8 — — DEBUG CLKOUTEN 7:0 Legend: 148 — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are unused by the slope compensation module. TABLE 17-3: Name SC1ISET<3:0> — CP MCLRE PWRTE Bit 11/3 Bit 10/2 WRT<1:0> WDTE Bit 9/1 Bit 8/0 BOREN<1:0> — Register on Page 162 FOSC0 — — = unimplemented location, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the slope compensation module. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 149 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 150 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 18.0 INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY The PIC16F753/HV753 instruction set is highly orthogonal and is comprised of three basic categories: TABLE 18-1: Field Each PIC16 instruction is a 14-bit word divided into an opcode, which specifies the instruction type and one or more operands, which further specify the operation of the instruction. The formats for each of the categories is presented in Figure 18-1, while the various opcode fields are summarized in Table 18-1. Table 18-2 lists the instructions recognized by the MPASMTM assembler. For byte-oriented instructions, ‘f’ represents a file register designator and ‘d’ represents a destination designator. The file register designator specifies which file register is to be used by the instruction. The destination designator specifies where the result of the operation is to be placed. If ‘d’ is zero, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is one, the result is placed in the file register specified in the instruction. For bit-oriented instructions, ‘b’ represents a bit field designator, which selects the bit affected by the operation, while ‘f’ represents the address of the file in which the bit is located. W Working register (accumulator) b Bit address within an 8-bit file register k Literal field, constant data or label x Don’t care location (= 0 or 1). The assembler will generate code with x = 0. It is the recommended form of use for compatibility with all Microchip software tools. d Destination select; d = 0: store result in W, d = 1: store result in file register f. Default is d = 1. PC Program Counter TO Time-out bit DC Digit carry bit Zero bit Z PD Power-down bit FIGURE 18-1: One instruction cycle consists of four oscillator periods; for an oscillator frequency of 4 MHz, this gives a normal instruction execution time of 1 s. All instructions are executed within a single instruction cycle, unless a conditional test is true, or the program counter is changed as a result of an instruction. When this occurs, the execution takes two instruction cycles, with the second cycle executed as a NOP. All instruction examples use the format ‘0xhh’ to represent a hexadecimal number, where ‘h’ signifies a hexadecimal digit. GENERAL FORMAT FOR INSTRUCTIONS Byte-oriented file register operations 13 8 7 6 OPCODE d f (FILE #) Any instruction that specifies a file register as part of the instruction performs a Read-Modify-Write (RMW) operation. The register is read, the data is modified, and the result is stored according to either the instruction or the destination designator ‘d’. A read operation is performed on a register even if the instruction writes to that register. For example, a CLRF PORTA instruction will read PORTA, clear all the data bits, then write the result back to PORTA. This example would have the unintended consequence of clearing the condition that set the IOCIF flag. Preliminary 0 d = 0 for destination W d = 1 for destination f f = 7-bit file register address Bit-oriented file register operations 13 10 9 7 6 OPCODE b (BIT #) f (FILE #) 0 b = 3-bit bit address f = 7-bit file register address Literal and control operations General 13 Read-Modify-Write Operations 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Carry bit C For literal and control operations, ‘k’ represents an 8-bit or 11-bit constant, or literal value. 18.1 Description Register file address (0x00 to 0x7F) f • Byte-oriented operations • Bit-oriented operations • Literal and control operations OPCODE FIELD DESCRIPTIONS 8 7 0 OPCODE k (literal) k = 8-bit immediate value CALL and GOTO instructions only 13 11 OPCODE 10 0 k (literal) k = 11-bit immediate value DS40001709A-page 151 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 18-2: PIC16F753/HV753 INSTRUCTION SET Mnemonic, Operands Description Cycles 14-Bit Opcode MSb LSb Status Affected Notes BYTE-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS ADDWF ANDWF CLRF CLRW COMF DECF DECFSZ INCF INCFSZ IORWF MOVF MOVWF NOP RLF RRF SUBWF SWAPF XORWF f, d f, d f – f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d f – f, d f, d f, d f, d f, d Add W and f AND W with f Clear f Clear W Complement f Decrement f Decrement f, Skip if 0 Increment f Increment f, Skip if 0 Inclusive OR W with f Move f Move W to f No Operation Rotate Left f through Carry Rotate Right f through Carry Subtract W from f Swap nibbles in f Exclusive OR W with f BCF BSF BTFSC BTFSS f, b f, b f, b f, b Bit Clear f Bit Set f Bit Test f, Skip if Clear Bit Test f, Skip if Set 1 1 1 1 1 1 1(2) 1 1(2) 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 dfff dfff lfff 0xxx dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff lfff 0xx0 dfff dfff dfff dfff dfff ffff ffff ffff xxxx ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff 0000 ffff ffff ffff ffff ffff 00bb 01bb 10bb 11bb bfff bfff bfff bfff ffff ffff ffff ffff 111x 1001 0kkk 0000 1kkk 1000 00xx 0000 01xx 0000 0000 110x 1010 kkkk kkkk kkkk 0110 kkkk kkkk kkkk 0000 kkkk 0000 0110 kkkk kkkk kkkk kkkk kkkk 0100 kkkk kkkk kkkk 1001 kkkk 1000 0011 kkkk kkkk 0111 0101 0001 0001 1001 0011 1011 1010 1111 0100 1000 0000 0000 1101 1100 0010 1110 0110 C, DC, Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z Z C C C, DC, Z Z 1, 2 1, 2 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2, 3 1, 2 1, 2, 3 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 1, 2 BIT-ORIENTED FILE REGISTER OPERATIONS 1 1 1 (2) 1 (2) 01 01 01 01 1, 2 1, 2 3 3 LITERAL AND CONTROL OPERATIONS ADDLW ANDLW CALL CLRWDT GOTO IORLW MOVLW RETFIE RETLW RETURN SLEEP SUBLW XORLW Note 1: 2: 3: k k k – k k k – k – – k k 1 1 2 1 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 1 1 Add literal and W AND literal with W Call Subroutine Clear Watchdog Timer Go to address Inclusive OR literal with W Move literal to W Return from interrupt Return with literal in W Return from Subroutine Go into Standby mode Subtract W from literal Exclusive OR literal with W 11 11 10 00 10 11 11 00 11 00 00 11 11 C, DC, Z Z TO, PD Z TO, PD C, DC, Z Z When an I/O register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF PORTA, 1), the value used will be that value present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and is driven low by an external device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’. If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and where applicable, d = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if assigned to the Timer0 module. If the Program Counter (PC) is modified, or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second cycle is executed as a NOP. DS40001709A-page 152 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 18.2 Instruction Descriptions ADDLW Add literal and W Syntax: [ label ] ADDLW Operands: 0 k 255 Operation: (W) + k (W) Status Affected: C, DC, Z Description: The contents of the W register are added to the 8-bit literal ‘k’ and the result is placed in the W register. k BCF Bit Clear f Syntax: [ label ] BCF Operands: 0 f 127 0b7 Operation: 0 (f<b>) Status Affected: None Description: Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is cleared. BSF Bit Set f Syntax: [ label ] BSF f,b ADDWF Add W and f Syntax: [ label ] ADDWF Operands: 0 f 127 d 0,1 Operands: 0 f 127 0b7 Operation: (W) + (f) (destination) Operation: 1 (f<b>) Status Affected: C, DC, Z Status Affected: None Description: Add the contents of the W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. Description: Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is set. ANDLW AND literal with W BTFSC Bit Test f, Skip if Clear Syntax: [ label ] ANDLW Syntax: [ label ] BTFSC f,b Operands: 0 k 255 Operands: Operation: (W) .AND. (k) (W) 0 f 127 0b7 Status Affected: Z Operation: skip if (f<b>) = 0 Description: The contents of W register are AND’ed with the 8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in the W register. Status Affected: None Description: ANDWF AND W with f If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘1’, the next instruction is executed. If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘0’, the next instruction is discarded, and a NOP is executed instead, making this a two-cycle instruction. f,d k Syntax: [ label ] ANDWF Operands: 0 f 127 d 0,1 Operation: (W) .AND. (f) (destination) f,d Status Affected: Z Description: AND the W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. f,b Preliminary DS40001709A-page 153 PIC16F753/HV753 BTFSS Bit Test f, Skip if Set CLRWDT Clear Watchdog Timer Syntax: [ label ] BTFSS f,b Syntax: [ label ] CLRWDT Operands: 0 f 127 0b<7 Operands: None Operation: 00h WDT 0 WDT prescaler, 1 TO 1 PD Status Affected: TO, PD Description: CLRWDT instruction resets the Watchdog Timer. It also resets the prescaler of the WDT. Status bits TO and PD are set. Operation: skip if (f<b>) = 1 Status Affected: None Description: If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘0’, the next instruction is executed. If bit ‘b’ is ‘1’, then the next instruction is discarded and a NOP is executed instead, making this a two-cycle instruction. CALL Call Subroutine COMF Complement f Syntax: [ label ] CALL k Syntax: [ label ] COMF Operands: 0 k 2047 Operands: Operation: (PC)+ 1 TOS, k PC<10:0>, (PCLATH<4:3>) PC<12:11> 0 f 127 d [0,1] f,d Operation: (f) (destination) Status Affected: Z Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are complemented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. DECF Decrement f Syntax: [ label ] DECF f,d Status Affected: None Description: Call Subroutine. First, return address (PC + 1) is pushed onto the stack. The 11-bit immediate address is loaded into PC bits <10:0>. The upper bits of the PC are loaded from PCLATH. CALL is a two-cycle instruction. CLRF Clear f Syntax: [ label ] CLRF Operands: 0 f 127 Operands: Operation: 00h (f) 1Z 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operation: (f) - 1 (destination) Status Affected: Z Status Affected: Z Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are cleared and the Z bit is set. Description: Decrement register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. CLRW Clear W Syntax: [ label ] CLRW f Operands: None Operation: 00h (W) 1Z Status Affected: Z Description: W register is cleared. Zero bit (Z) is set. DS40001709A-page 154 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 DECFSZ Decrement f, Skip if 0 INCFSZ Increment f, Skip if 0 Syntax: [ label ] DECFSZ f,d Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operation: (f) - 1 (destination); skip if result = 0 Operation: (f) + 1 (destination), skip if result = 0 Status Affected: None Status Affected: None Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. If the result is ‘1’, the next instruction is executed. If the result is ‘0’, then a NOP is executed instead, making it a two-cycle instruction. Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. If the result is ‘1’, the next instruction is executed. If the result is ‘0’, a NOP is executed instead, making it a two-cycle instruction. GOTO Unconditional Branch IORLW Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 k 2047 Operands: 0 k 255 Operation: k PC<10:0> PCLATH<4:3> PC<12:11> Operation: (W) .OR. k (W) Status Affected: Z Status Affected: None Description: Description: GOTO is an unconditional branch. The 11-bit immediate value is loaded into PC bits <10:0>. The upper bits of PC are loaded from PCLATH<4:3>. GOTO is a two-cycle instruction. The contents of the W register are OR’ed with the 8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in the W register. INCF Increment f IORWF Inclusive OR W with f Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operation: (f) + 1 (destination) Operation: (W) .OR. (f) (destination) Status Affected: Z Status Affected: Z Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. Description: Inclusive OR the W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. GOTO k INCF f,d 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary INCFSZ f,d Inclusive OR literal with W IORLW k IORWF f,d DS40001709A-page 155 PIC16F753/HV753 MOVWF Move W to f Syntax: [ label ] MOVF Move f Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operands: 0 f 127 Operation: (W) (f) Operation: (f) (dest) Status Affected: None Status Affected: Z Description: Description: The contents of register ‘f’ is moved to a destination dependent upon the status of ‘d’. If d = 0, destination is W register. If d = 1, the destination is file register ‘f’ itself. d = 1 is useful to test a file register since Status flag Z is affected. Move data from W register to register ‘f’. Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Example: MOVF f,d MOVF Example: MOVW F MOVWF OPTION Before Instruction OPTION = W = After Instruction OPTION = W = FSR, 0 f 0xFF 0x4F 0x4F 0x4F After Instruction W = value in FSR register Z = 1 MOVLW Move literal to W NOP No Operation Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] Operands: 0 k 255 Operands: None Operation: k (W) Operation: No operation Status Affected: None Status Affected: None Description: The 8-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into W register. The “don’t cares” will assemble as ‘0’s. Description: No operation. Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Example: MOVLW k Example: MOVLW NOP 0x5A After Instruction W = DS40001709A-page 156 NOP 0x5A Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 RETFIE Return from Interrupt RETLW Return with literal in W Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] Operands: None Operands: 0 k 255 Operation: TOS PC, 1 GIE Operation: k (W); TOS PC Status Affected: None Status Affected: None Description: Return from Interrupt. Stack is POPed and Top-of-Stack (TOS) is loaded in the PC. Interrupts are enabled by setting Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>). This is a two-cycle instruction. Description: The W register is loaded with the 8-bit literal ‘k’. The program counter is loaded from the top of the stack (the return address). This is a two-cycle instruction. Words: 1 Cycles: 2 Example: RETFIE Words: 1 Cycles: 2 Example: RETFIE After Interrupt PC = GIE = TOS 1 TABLE RETLW k CALL TABLE;W contains ;table offset ;value GOTO DONE • • ADDWF PC ;W = offset RETLW k1 ;Begin table RETLW k2 ; • • • RETLW kn ;End of table DONE Before Instruction W = 0x07 After Instruction W = value of k8 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. RETURN Return from Subroutine Syntax: [ label ] Operands: None Operation: TOS PC Status Affected: None Description: Return from subroutine. The stack is POPed and the top of the stack (TOS) is loaded into the program counter. This is a two-cycle instruction. Preliminary RETURN DS40001709A-page 157 PIC16F753/HV753 RLF Rotate Left f through Carry SLEEP Enter Sleep mode Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] SLEEP Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operands: None Operation: Operation: See description below Status Affected: C Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated 1 bit to the left through the Carry flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. 00h WDT, 0 WDT prescaler, 1 TO, 0 PD RLF f,d C Words: 1 Cycles: 1 Example: Status Affected: TO, PD Description: The power-down Status bit, PD is cleared. Time-out Status bit, TO is set. Watchdog Timer and its prescaler are cleared. The processor is put into Sleep mode with the oscillator stopped. Register f RLF REG1,0 Before Instruction REG1 C = = 1110 0110 0 = = = 1110 0110 1100 1100 1 After Instruction REG1 W C RRF Rotate Right f through Carry SUBLW Syntax: [ label ] Syntax: [ label ] SUBLW k Operands: 0 k 255 k - (W) W) RRF f,d Subtract W from literal Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operation: Operation: See description below Status Affected: C, DC, Z Status Affected: C Description: Description: The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated 1 bit to the right through the Carry flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in register ‘f’. C DS40001709A-page 158 Register f Preliminary The W register is subtracted (2’s complement method) from the 8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in the W register. Result Condition C=0 Wk C=1 Wk DC = 0 W<3:0> k<3:0> DC = 1 W<3:0> k<3:0> 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 SUBWF Subtract W from f XORWF Exclusive OR W with f Syntax: [ label ] SUBWF f,d Syntax: [ label ] XORWF Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operation: (f) - (W) destination) Operation: (W) .XOR. (f) destination) Status Affected: C, DC, Z Status Affected: Z Description: Description: Exclusive OR the contents of the W register with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. Subtract (2’s complement method) W register from register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back in register ‘f’. C=0 Wf C=1 Wf DC = 0 W<3:0> f<3:0> DC = 1 W<3:0> f<3:0> SWAPF Swap Nibbles in f Syntax: [ label ] SWAPF f,d Operands: 0 f 127 d [0,1] Operation: (f<3:0>) (destination<7:4>), (f<7:4>) (destination<3:0>) Status Affected: None Description: The upper and lower nibbles of register ‘f’ are exchanged. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in the W register. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed in register ‘f’. XORLW f,d Exclusive OR literal with W Syntax: [ label ] XORLW k Operands: 0 k 255 Operation: (W) .XOR. k W) Status Affected: Z Description: The contents of the W register are XOR’ed with the 8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in the W register. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 159 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 160 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 19.0 SPECIAL FEATURES OF THE CPU The PIC16F753/HV753 has a host of features intended to maximize system reliability, minimize cost through elimination of external components, provide powersaving features and offer code protection. These features are: 19.1 The Configuration bits can be programmed (read as ‘0’), or left unprogrammed (read as ‘1’) to select various device configurations as shown in Register 19-1. These bits are mapped in program memory location 2007h. Note: • Reset - Power-on Reset (POR) - Power-up Timer (PWRT) - Brown-out Reset (BOR) • Interrupts • Watchdog Timer (WDT) • Oscillator selection • Sleep • Code protection • ID Locations • In-Circuit Serial Programming™ Configuration Bits Address 2007h is beyond the user program memory space. It belongs to the special configuration memory space (2000h3FFFh), which can be accessed only during programming. See the “PIC16F753/HV753 Flash Memory Programming Specification” (DS41686) for more information. The Power-up Timer (PWRT), which provides a fixed delay of 64 ms (nominal) on power-up only, is designed to keep the part in Reset while the power supply stabilizes. There is also circuitry to reset the device if a brown-out occurs, which can use the Power-up Timer to provide at least a 64 ms Reset. With these functionson-chip, most applications need no external Reset circuitry. The Sleep mode is designed to offer a very low-current Power-Down mode. The user can wake-up from Sleep through: • External Reset • Watchdog Timer Wake-up • An interrupt Oscillator selection options are available to allow the part to fit the application. The INTOSC options save system cost, while the External Clock (EC) option provides a means for specific frequency and accurate clock sources. Configuration bits are used to select various options (see Register 19-1). 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 161 PIC16F753/HV753 REGISTER 19-1: CONFIGURATION WORD R/P-1 R/P-1 DEBUG CLKOUTEN R/P-1 R/P-1 R/P-1 WRT<1:0> R/P-1 BOREN<1:0> bit 13 bit 8 U-1 R/P-1 R/P-1 R/P-1 R/P-1 U-1 U-1 R/P-1 — CP MCLRE PWRTE WDTE — — FOSC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit P = Programmable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘1’ ‘0’ = Bit is cleared ‘1’ = Bit is set -n = Value when blank or after Bulk Erase bit 13 DEBUG: Debug Mode Enable bit(2) 1 = Background debugger is disabled 0 = Background debugger is enabled bit 12 CLKOUTEN: Clock Out Enable bit 1 = Clock out function disabled. CLKOUT pin acts as I/O pin 0 = General purpose I/O disabled. CLKOUT pin acts as CLKOUT bit 11-10 WRT<1:0>: Flash Program Memory Self Write Enable bit 11 = Write protection off 10 = 000h to FFh write-protected, 100h to 3FFh may be modified by PMCON1 control 01 = 000h to 1FFh write-protected, 200h to 3FFh may be modified by PMCON1 control 00 = 000h to 3FFh write-protected, entire program is write-protected bit 8-9 BOREN<1:0>: Brown-out Reset Enable bits 11 = BOR enabled 10 = BOR enabled during operation and disabled in Sleep 0x = BOR disabled bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘1’ bit 6 CP: Code Protection bit 1 = Program memory code protection is disabled 0 = Program memory code protection is enabled bit 5 MCLRE: MCLR/VPP Pin Function Select bit 1 = MCLR pin is MCLR function and weak internal pull-up is enabled 0 = MCLR pin is input function, MCLR function is internally disabled bit 4 PWRTE: Power-up Timer Enable bit(1) 1 = PWRT disabled 0 = PWRT enabled bit 3 WDTE: Watchdog Timer Enable bit 1 = WDT enabled 0 = WDT disabled bit 2-1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘1’ bit 0 FOSC: Oscillator Selection bits 1 = EC oscillator selected: CLKIN on RA5/CLKIN 0 = Internal oscillator: I/O function on RA5/CLKIN Note 1: 2: Enabling Brown-out Reset does not automatically enable Power-up Timer. The Configuration bit is managed automatically by the device development tools. The user should not attempt to manually write this bit location. However, the user should ensure that this location has been programmed to a ‘1’ and the device checksum is correct for proper operation of production software. DS40001709A-page 162 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 19.2 Calibration Bits The 8 MHz internal oscillator is factory calibrated. These calibration values are stored in fuses located in the Calibration Word (2008h). The Calibration Word is not erased when using the specified bulk erase sequence in the “PIC16F753/HV753 Flash Memory Programming Specification” (DS41686) and thus, does not require reprogramming. 19.3 Reset The PIC16F753/HV753 device differentiates between various kinds of Reset: a) b) c) d) e) f) Power-on Reset (POR) WDT Reset during normal operation WDT Reset during Sleep MCLR Reset during normal operation MCLR Reset during Sleep Brown-out Reset (BOR) Some registers are not affected in any Reset condition; their status is unknown on POR and unchanged in any other Reset. Most other registers are reset to a “Reset state” on: • • • • • Power-on Reset MCLR Reset MCLR Reset during Sleep WDT Reset Brown-out Reset (BOR) WDT wake-up does not cause register Resets in the same manner as a WDT Reset since wake-up is viewed as the resumption of normal operation. TO and PD bits are set or cleared differently in different Reset situations, as indicated in Table 19-2. Software can use these bits to determine the nature of the Reset. See Table 19-4 for a full description of Reset states of all registers. A simplified block diagram of the On-Chip Reset Circuit is shown in Figure 19-1. The MCLR Reset path has a noise filter to detect and ignore small pulses. See Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications” for pulse-width specifications. FIGURE 19-1: SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF ON-CHIP RESET CIRCUIT External Reset MCLR/VPP pin Sleep WDT Module WDT Time-out Reset VDD Rise Detect Power-on Reset VDD Brown-out(1) Reset BOREN S PWRT On-Chip RC OSC Chip_Reset R 11-bit Ripple Counter Q Enable PWRT Note 1: Refer to the Configuration Word register (Register 19-1). 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 163 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 19-1: TIME-OUT IN VARIOUS SITUATIONS Oscillator Configuration EC, INTOSC TABLE 19-2: Power-up Brown-out Reset PWRTE = 0 PWRTE = 1 PWRTE = 0 PWRTE = 1 Wake-up from Sleep TPWRT — TPWRT — — STATUS/PCON BITS AND THEIR SIGNIFICANCE POR BOR TO PD Condition 0 x 1 1 Power-on Reset u 0 1 1 Brown-out Reset u u 0 u WDT Reset u u 0 0 WDT Wake-up u u u u MCLR Reset during normal operation u u 1 0 MCLR Reset during Sleep Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown 19.3.1 19.3.2 POWER-ON RESET (POR) The on-chip POR circuit holds the chip in Reset until VDD has reached a high enough level for proper operation. To take advantage of the POR, simply connect the MCLR pin through a resistor to VDD. This will eliminate external RC components usually needed to create Power-on Reset. A maximum rise time for VDD is required. See Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications” for details. If the BOR is enabled, the maximum rise time specification does not apply. The BOR circuitry will keep the device in Reset until VDD reaches VBOR (see Section 19.3.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”). Note: The POR circuit does not produce an internal Reset when VDD declines. To reenable the POR, VDD must reach Vss for a minimum of 100 s. When the device starts normal operation (exits the Reset condition), device operating parameters (i.e., voltage, frequency, temperature, etc.) must be met to ensure proper operation. If these conditions are not met, the device must be held in Reset until the operating conditions are met. MCLR PIC16F753/HV753 has a noise filter in the MCLR Reset path. The filter will detect and ignore small pulses. It should be noted that a WDT Reset does not drive MCLR pin low. Voltages applied to the MCLR pin that exceed its specification can result in both MCLR Resets and excessive current beyond the device specification during the ESD event. For this reason, Microchip recommends that the MCLR pin no longer be tied directly to VDD. The use of an RC network, as shown in Figure 19-2, is suggested. An internal MCLR option is enabled by clearing the MCLRE bit in the Configuration Word register. When MCLRE = 0, the Reset signal to the chip is generated internally. When the MCLRE = 1, the MCLR pin becomes an external Reset input. In this mode, the MCLR pin has a weak pull-up to VDD. FIGURE 19-2: RECOMMENDED MCLR CIRCUIT VDD For additional information, refer to Application Note AN607, “Power-up Trouble Shooting” (DS00607). R1 1 kor greater) PIC® MCU R2 MCLR SW1 (optional) 100 needed with capacitor) C1 0.1 F (optional, not critical) DS40001709A-page 164 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 19.3.3 POWER-UP TIMER (PWRT) 19.3.4 The Power-up Timer provides a fixed 64 ms (nominal) time-out on power-up only, from POR or Brown-out Reset. The Power-up Timer operates from an internal RC oscillator. For more information, see Section 4.2.2 “Internal Clock Mode”. The chip is kept in Reset as long as PWRT is active. The PWRT delay allows the VDD to rise to an acceptable level. A Configuration bit, PWRTE, can disable (if set) or enable (if cleared or programmed) the Power-up Timer. The Power-up Timer should be enabled when Brown-out Reset is enabled, although it is not required. The BOREN<1:0> bits in the Configuration Word register select one of three BOR modes. One mode has been added to allow control of the BOR enable for lower current during Sleep. By selecting BOREN<1:0> = 10, the BOR is automatically disabled in Sleep to conserve power and enabled on wake-up. See Register 19-1 for the Configuration Word definition. A brown-out occurs when VDD falls below VBOR for greater than parameter TBOR (see Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications”). The brown-out condition will reset the device. This will occur regardless of VDD slew rate. A Brown-out Reset may not occur if VDD falls below VBOR for less than parameter TBOR. The Power-up Timer delay will vary from chip-to-chip due to: • VDD variation • Temperature variation • Process variation See DC parameters for details “Electrical Specifications”). Note: BROWN-OUT RESET (BOR) On any Reset (Power-on, Brown-out Reset, Watchdog timer, etc.), the chip will remain in Reset until VDD rises above VBOR (see Figure 19-3). If enabled, the Powerup Timer will be invoked by the Reset and keep the chip in Reset an additional 64 ms. (Section 22.0 Note: Voltage spikes below VSS at the MCLR pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA, may cause latch-up. Thus, a series resistor of 50-100 should be used when applying a “low” level to the MCLR pin, rather than pulling this pin directly to VSS. The Power-up Timer is enabled by the PWRTE bit in the Configuration Word register. If VDD drops below VBOR while the Power-up Timer is running, the chip will go back into a Brown-out Reset and the Power-up Timer will be re-initialized. Once VDD rises above VBOR, the Power-up Timer will execute a 64 ms Reset. Table 19-3 summarizes the registers associated with BOR. FIGURE 19-3: BROWN-OUT SITUATIONS VDD Internal Reset Vbor 64 ms(1) VDD Internal Reset Vbor < 64 ms 64 ms(1) Vdd Vbor Internal Reset Note 1: 64 ms(1) 64 ms delay only if PWRTE bit is programmed to ‘0’. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 165 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 19-3: Name SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH BROWN-OUT RESET Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page — — — — — — POR BOR 24 IRP RP1 RP0 TO PD Z DC C 17 PCON STATUS Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition. Shaded cells are not used by BOR. 19.3.5 19.3.6 TIME-OUT SEQUENCE On power-up, the time-out sequence is as follows: • PWRT time-out is invoked after POR has expired. • OST is activated after the PWRT time-out has expired. The total time-out will vary based on oscillator configuration and PWRTE bit status. For example, in EC mode with PWRTE bit erased (PWRT disabled), there will be no time-out at all. Figure 19-4, Figure 19-5 and Figure 19-6 depict time-out sequences. Since the time-outs occur from the POR pulse, if MCLR is kept low long enough, the time-outs will expire. Then, bringing MCLR high will begin execution immediately (see Figure 19-5). This is useful for testing purposes or to synchronize more than one PIC16F753/HV753 device operating in parallel. Table 19-5 shows the Reset conditions for some special registers, while Table 19-4 shows the Reset conditions for all the registers. FIGURE 19-4: POWER CONTROL (PCON) REGISTER The Power Control register PCON (address 8Eh) has two Status bits to indicate what type of Reset occurred last. Bit 0 is BOR (Brown-out). BOR is unknown on Poweron Reset. It must then be set by the user and checked on subsequent Resets to see if BOR = 0, indicating that a Brown-out has occurred. The BOR Status bit is a “don’t care” and is not necessarily predictable if the brown-out circuit is disabled (BOREN<1:0> = 00 in the Configuration Word register). Bit 1 is POR (Power-on Reset). It is a ‘0’ on Power-on Reset and unaffected otherwise. The user must write a ‘1’ to this bit following a Power-on Reset. On a subsequent Reset, if POR is ‘0’, it will indicate that a Poweron Reset has occurred (i.e., VDD may have gone too low). For more information, see Section 19.3.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”. TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (DELAYED MCLR): CASE 1 VDD MCLR Internal POR TPWRT PWRT Time-out TIOSCST OST Time-out Internal Reset DS40001709A-page 166 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 19-5: TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (DELAYED MCLR): CASE 2 VDD MCLR Internal POR TPWRT PWRT Time-out TIOSCST OST Time-out Internal Reset TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR WITH VDD) FIGURE 19-6: VDD MCLR Internal POR TPWRT PWRT Time-out TIOSCST OST Time-out Internal Reset 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 167 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 19-4: Register W INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR REGISTERS Address Power-on Reset MCLR Reset WDT Reset Brown-out Reset(1) Wake-up from Sleep through Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep through WDT Time-out — xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu INDF 00h/80h/ 100h/180h xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu TMR0 01h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu PCL 02h/82h/ 102h/182h 0000 0000 0000 0000 PC + 1(3) STATUS 03h/83h/ 103h/183h 0001 1xxx 000q quuu(4) uuuq quuu(4) FSR 04h/84h/ 104h/184h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu PORTA 05h --xx xxxx --uu uuuu --uu uuuu IOCAF 08h --00 0000 --00 0000 --uu uuuu PCLATH 0Ah/8Ah/ 10Ah/18Ah ---0 0000 ---0 0000 ---u uuuu INTCON 0Bh/8Bh/ 10Bh/18Bh 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu(2) PIR1 0Ch 00-- -0-0 00-- -0-0 uu-- -u-u(2) PIR2 0Dh --00 -0-0 --00 -0-0 --uu -u-u(2) TMR1L 0Fh xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu TMR1H 10h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu T1CON 11h 0000 00-0 uuuu uu-u uuuu uu-u T1GCON 12h 0000 0x00 0000 0x00 uuuu uuuu (1) 13h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu CCPR1H(1) 14h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu CCP1CON(1) 15h --00 0000 --00 0000 --uu uuuu ADRESL(1) 1Ch xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu ADRESH(1) 1Dh xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu ADCON0(1) 1Eh 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu ADCON1(1) 1Fh -000 ---- -000 ---- -uuu ---- 81h/181h 1111 1111 1111 1111 uuuu uuuu TRISA 85h --11 1111 --11 1111 --uu uuuu IOCAP 88h --00 0000 --00 0000 --uu uuuu PIE1 8Ch 00-- -000 00-- -000 uu-- -uuu PIE2 8Dh --00 -0-0 --00 -0-0 --uu -u-u OSCCON 8Fh --01 -00- --uu -uu- --uu -uu- FVRCON 90h 0000 ---- 0000 ---- uuuu ---- DACCON0 91h 000- -0-- 000- -0-- uuu- -u-- DACCON1 92h ---0 0000 ---0 0000 ---u uuuu 9Bh 0000 0100 0000 0100 uuuu uuuu CCPR1L OPTION_REG CM2CON0 Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition. If VDD goes too low, Power-on Reset will be activated and registers will be affected differently. One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIRx will be affected (to cause wake-up). When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h). See Table 19-5 for Reset value for specific condition. If Reset was due to brown-out, then bit 0 = 0. All other Resets will cause bit 0 = u. DS40001709A-page 168 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 19-4: INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR REGISTERS (CONTINUED) Wake-up from Sleep through Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep through WDT Time-out Address Power-on Reset MCLR Reset WDT Reset Brown-out Reset(1) CM2CON1 9Ch 0000 ---0 0000 ---0 uuuu ---u CM1CON0 9Dh 0000 0100 0000 0100 uuuu uuuu CM1CON1 9Eh 0000 ---0 0000 ---0 uuuu ---u CMOUT 9Fh ---- --00 ---- --00 ---- --uu LATA 105h --xx -xxx --uu -uuu --uu -uuu IOCAN 108h --00 0000 --00 0000 --uu uuuu WPUA 10Ch --00 0000 --00 0000 --uu uuuu SLRCON0 10Dh ---- -0-0 ---- -0-0 ---- -u-u PCON 10Fh ---- --qq TMR2 110h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu PR2 111h 1111 1111 1111 1111 uuuu uuuu T2CON 112h -000 0000 -000 0000 -uuu uuuu HLTMR1 113h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu HLTPR1 114h 1111 1111 1111 1111 uuuu uuuu HLT1CON0 115h -000 0000 -000 0000 -uuu uuuu HLT1CON1 116h ---0 0000 ---0 0000 ---u uuuu ANSELA 185h --11 -111 --11 -111 --uu -uuu APFCON 188h ---0 -000 ---0 -000 ---u -uuu OSCTUNE 189h ---0 0000 ---u uuuu ---u uuuu PMCON1 18Ch ---- -000 ---- -000 ---- -uuu PMCON2 18Dh ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- ---- PMADRL 18Eh 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu PMADRH 18Fh ---- --00 ---- --00 ---- --uu PMDATL 190h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu PMDATH 191h --00 0000 --00 0000 --uu uuuu COG1PH 192h ---- xxxx ---- uuuu ---- uuuu COG1BLK 193h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu COG1DB 194h xxxx xxxx uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu COG1CON0 195h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu COG1CON1 196h --00 0000 --00 0000 --uu uuuu COG1ASD 197h 0000 0000 0000 0000 uuuu uuuu Register Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: ---- --uu(1, 5) ---- --uu u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition. If VDD goes too low, Power-on Reset will be activated and registers will be affected differently. One or more bits in INTCON and/or PIRx will be affected (to cause wake-up). When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIE bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h). See Table 19-5 for Reset value for specific condition. If Reset was due to brown-out, then bit 0 = 0. All other Resets will cause bit 0 = u. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 169 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 19-5: INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR SPECIAL REGISTERS Program Counter Status Register PCON Register Power-on Reset 000h 0001 1xxx ---- --0x MCLR Reset during normal operation 000h 000u uuuu ---- --uu MCLR Reset during Sleep 000h 0001 0uuu ---- --uu 000h 0000 uuuu ---- --uu PC + 1 uuu0 0uuu ---- --uu Condition WDT Reset WDT Wake-up Brown-out Reset Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep 000h 0001 1uuu ---- --u0 PC + 1(1) uuu1 0uuu ---- --uu Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, reads as ‘0’. Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt vector (0004h) after execution of PC + 1. DS40001709A-page 170 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 19.4 Interrupts The PIC16F753/HV753 has multiple sources of interrupt: • • • • • • • • • • • External Interrupt (INT pin) Interrupt-On-Change (IOC) Interrupts Timer0 Overflow Interrupt Timer1 Overflow Interrupt Timer2 Match Interrupt Hardware Limit Timer (HLT) Interrupt Comparator Interrupt (C1/C2) ADC Interrupt Complementary Output Generator (COG) CCP1 Interrupt Flash Memory Self Write For external interrupt events, such as the INT pin or PORTA change interrupt, the interrupt latency will be three or four instruction cycles. The exact latency depends upon when the interrupt event occurs (see Figure 19-8). The latency is the same for one or twocycle instructions. Once in the Interrupt Service Routine, the source(s) of the interrupt can be determined by polling the interrupt flag bits. The interrupt flag bit(s) must be cleared in software before re-enabling interrupts to avoid multiple interrupt requests. Note 1: Individual interrupt flag bits are set, regardless of the status of their corresponding mask bit or the GIE bit. 2: When an instruction that clears the GIE bit is executed, any interrupts that were pending for execution in the next cycle are ignored. The interrupts, which were ignored, are still pending to be serviced when the GIE bit is set again. The Interrupt Control register (INTCON) and Peripheral Interrupt Request Registers (PIRx) record individual interrupt requests in flag bits. The INTCON register also has individual and global interrupt enable bits. The Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE of the INTCON register, enables (if set) all unmasked interrupts, or disables (if cleared) all interrupts. Individual interrupts can be disabled through their corresponding enable bits in the INTCON register and PIEx registers. GIE is cleared on Reset. When an interrupt is serviced, the following actions occur automatically: • The GIE is cleared to disable any further interrupt. • The return address is pushed onto the stack. • The PC is loaded with 0004h. The Return from Interrupt instruction, RETFIE, exits the interrupt routine, as well as sets the GIE bit, which re-enables unmasked interrupts. The following interrupt flags are contained in the INTCON register: • INT Pin Interrupt • Interrupt-On-Change (IOC) Interrupts • Timer0 Overflow Interrupt For additional information on Timer1, Timer2, comparators, ADC, Enhanced CCP modules, refer to the respective peripheral section. 19.4.1 RA2/INT INTERRUPT The external interrupt on the RA2/INT pin is edgetriggered; either on the rising edge if the INTEDG bit of the OPTION register is set, or the falling edge, if the INTEDG bit is clear. When a valid edge appears on the RA2/INT pin, the INTF bit of the INTCON register is set. This interrupt can be disabled by clearing the INTE control bit of the INTCON register. The INTF bit must be cleared by software in the Interrupt Service Routine before re-enabling this interrupt. The RA2/INT interrupt can wake-up the processor from Sleep, if the INTE bit was set prior to going into Sleep. See Section 19.7 “Power-Down Mode (Sleep)” for details on Sleep and Figure 19-10 for timing of wake-up from Sleep through RA2/INT interrupt. Note: The peripheral interrupt flags are contained in the PIR1 and PIR2 registers. The corresponding interrupt enable bit is contained in the PIE1 and PIE2 registers. The ANSEL register must be initialized to configure an analog channel as a digital input. Pins configured as analog inputs will read ‘0’ and cannot generate an interrupt. The following interrupt flags are contained in the PIR1 register: • • • • • A/D Interrupt Comparator Interrupt Timer1 Overflow Interrupt Timer2 Match Interrupt Enhanced CCP Interrupt 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 171 PIC16F753/HV753 19.4.2 TIMER0 INTERRUPT An overflow (FFh 00h) in the TMR0 register will set the T0IF bit of the INTCON register. The interrupt can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing T0IE bit of the INTCON register. See Section 6.0 “Timer0 Module” for operation of the Timer0 module. 19.4.3 PORTA INTERRUPT-ON-CHANGE An input change on PORTA sets the IOCIF bit of the INTCON register. The interrupt can be enabled/ disabled by setting/clearing the IOCIE bit of the INTCON register. Plus, individual pins can be configured through the IOC register. Note: If a change on the I/O pin should occur when any PORTA operation is being executed, then the IOCIF interrupt flag may not get set. FIGURE 19-7: INTERRUPT LOGIC T0IF T0IE Peripheral Interrupts (TMR1IF) PIR1<0> (TMR1IF) PIR1<0> Wake-up (If in Sleep mode) INTF INTE IOCIF IOCIE Interrupt to CPU PEIE PIRn<7> PIEn<7> DS40001709A-page 172 GIE Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 19-8: INT PIN INTERRUPT TIMING Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 CLKIN CLKOUT (3) (4) INT pin (1) (1) INTF flag (INTCON reg.) Interrupt Latency (2) (5) GIE bit (INTCON reg.) INSTRUCTION FLOW PC Instruction Fetched PC + 1 Inst (PC + 1) Inst (PC) Instruction Executed Note 1: PC 0005h Inst (0004h) Inst (0005h) Dummy Cycle Inst (0004h) — Dummy Cycle Inst (PC) Inst (PC – 1) 0004h PC + 1 INTF flag is sampled here (every Q1). 2: Asynchronous interrupt latency = 3-4 TCY. Synchronous latency = 3 TCY, where TCY = instruction cycle time. Latency is the same whether Inst (PC) is a single cycle or a 2-cycle instruction. 3: CLKOUT is available only in INTOSC and RC Oscillator modes. 4: For minimum width of INT pulse, refer to AC specifications in Section 22.0 “Electrical Specifications”. 5: INTF is enabled to be set any time during the Q4-Q1 cycles. TABLE 19-6: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH INTERRUPTS Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page INTCON GIE PEIE T0IE INTE IOCIE T0IF INTF IOCIF 19 IOCAF — — IOCAF5 IOCAF4 IOCAF3 IOCAF2 IOCAF1 IOCAF0 49 IOCAN — — IOCAN5 IOCAN4 IOCAN3 IOCAN2 IOCAN1 IOCAN0 49 IOCAP — — IOCAP5 IOCAP4 IOCAP3 IOCAP2 IOCAP1 IOCAP0 49 LATA — — LATA5 LATA4 — LATA2 LATA1 LATA0 46 PIE1 TMR1GIE ADIE — — HLTMR2IE HLTMR1IE TMR2IE TMR1IE 20 PIR1 TMR1GIF ADIF — — HLTMR2IF HLTMR1IF TMR2IF TMR1IF 22 Legend: x = unknown, u = unchanged, – = unimplemented read as ‘0’, q = value depends upon condition. Shaded cells are not used by the interrupt module. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 173 PIC16F753/HV753 19.5 Context Saving During Interrupts During an interrupt, only the return PC value is saved on the stack. Typically, users may wish to save key registers during an interrupt (e.g., W and STATUS registers). This must be implemented in software. Temporary holding registers W_TEMP and STATUS_TEMP should be placed in the last 16 bytes of GPR (see Figure 2-2). These 16 locations are common to all banks and do not require banking. This makes context save and restore operations simpler. The code shown in Example 19-1 can be used to: • • • • • Store the W register Store the STATUS register Execute the ISR code Restore the Status (and Bank Select Bit register) Restore the W register Note: The PIC16F753/HV753 does not require saving the PCLATH. However, if computed GOTOs are used in both the ISR and the main code, the PCLATH must be saved and restored in the ISR. EXAMPLE 19-1: MOVWF SWAPF SAVING STATUS AND W REGISTERS IN RAM W_TEMP STATUS,W MOVWF STATUS_TEMP : :(ISR) : SWAPF STATUS_TEMP,W MOVWF SWAPF SWAPF 19.6 STATUS W_TEMP,F W_TEMP,W ;Copy W to TEMP ;Swap status to ;Swaps are used ;Save status to ;Insert user code here ;Swap STATUS_TEMP register into W ;(sets bank to original state) ;Move W into STATUS register ;Swap W_TEMP ;Swap W_TEMP into W Watchdog Timer (WDT) 19.6.1 The Watchdog Timer is a free running timer, using LFINTOSC oscillator as its clock source. The WDT is enabled by setting the WDTE bit of the Configuration Word (default setting). When WDTE is set, the LFINTOSC will always be enabled to provide a clock source to the WDT module. During normal operation, a WDT time-out generates a device Reset. If the device is in Sleep mode, a WDT time-out causes the device to wake-up and continue with normal operation. The WDT can be permanently disabled by programming the Configuration bit, WDTE, as clear (Section 19.1 “Configuration Bits”). DS40001709A-page 174 register be saved into W because they do not affect the status bits bank zero STATUS_TEMP register WDT PERIOD The WDT has a nominal time-out period of 18 ms (with no prescaler). The time-out periods vary with temperature, VDD and process variations from part to part (see DC specs). If longer time-out periods are desired, a prescaler with a division ratio of up to 1:128 can be assigned to the WDT under software control by writing to the OPTION register. Thus, time-out periods up to 2.3 seconds can be realized. The CLRWDT and SLEEP instructions clear the WDT and the prescaler, if assigned to the WDT, and prevent it from timing out and generating a device Reset. The TO bit in the STATUS register will be cleared upon a Watchdog Timer time-out. Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 19.6.2 WDT PROGRAMMING CONSIDERATIONS It should also be taken in account that under worstcase conditions (i.e., VDD = Min., Temperature = Max., Max. WDT prescaler) it may take several seconds before a WDT time-out occurs. FIGURE 19-9: WATCHDOG TIMER WITH SHARED PRESCALE BLOCK DIAGRAM FOSC/4 Data Bus 0 8 1 1 T0CKI pin T0CS T0SE Sync 2 TCY Shared Prescale TMR0 0 0 Set Flag bit T0IF on Overflow PSA 8-bit Prescaler 1 PSA 8 PS<2:0> Watchdog Timer LFINTOSC WDT Time-out 2 (Figure 4-1) 1 0 PSA PSA WDTE Note 1: T0SE, T0CS, PSA, PS<2:0> are bits in the OPTION_REG register. 2: WDTE bit is in the Configuration Word register. TABLE 19-7: WDT STATUS Conditions WDT WDTE = 0 CLRWDT Command Cleared Exit Sleep 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 175 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 19-8: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH WATCHDOG TIMER Name Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 OPTION_REG RAPU INTEDG T0CS T0SE PSA Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Register on Page 61 PS<2:0> Legend: Shaded cells are not used by the Watchdog Timer. TABLE 19-9: Name CONFIG(1) Legend: Note 1: SUMMARY OF CONFIGURATION WORD WITH WATCHDOG TIMER Bits Bit -/7 Bit -/6 Bit 13/5 Bit 12/4 13:8 7:0 — — DEBUG CLKOUTEN — CP MCLRE PWRTE Bit 11/3 Bit 10/2 WRT<1:0> WDTE Bit 9/1 Bit 8/0 BOREN<1:0> — — FOSC0 Register on Page 162 — = unimplemented location, read as ‘1’. Shaded cells are not used by Watchdog Timer. See Register 19-1 for operation of all Configuration Word register bits. DS40001709A-page 176 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 19.7 Power-Down Mode (Sleep) The Power-Down mode is entered by executing a SLEEP instruction. If the Watchdog Timer is enabled: • • • • • WDT will be cleared but keeps running PD bit in the STATUS register is cleared TO bit is set Oscillator driver is turned off I/O ports maintain the status they had before SLEEP was executed (driving high, low or high-impedance). For lowest current consumption in this mode, all I/O pins should be either at VDD or VSS, with no external circuitry drawing current from the I/O pin and the comparators, DAC and FVR should be disabled. I/O pins that are highimpedance inputs should be pulled high or low externally to avoid switching currents caused by floating inputs. The T0CKI input should also be at VDD or VSS for lowest current consumption. The contribution from on-chip pullups on PORTA should be considered. The MCLR pin must be at a logic high level. Note: 19.7.1 It should be noted that a Reset generated by a WDT time-out does not drive MCLR pin low. WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP The device can wake-up from Sleep through one of the following events: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. External Reset input on MCLR pin. Watchdog Timer wake-up. Interrupt from INT pin. Interrupt-On-Change input change. Peripheral interrupt. The first event will cause a device Reset. The other events are considered a continuation of program execution. The TO and PD bits in the STATUS register can be used to determine the cause of device Reset. The PD bit, which is set on power-up, is cleared when Sleep is invoked. TO bit is cleared if WDT wake-up occurred. The following peripheral interrupts can wake the device from Sleep: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Timer1 interrupt. Timer1 must be operating as an asynchronous counter. CCP Capture mode interrupt. A/D conversion (when A/D clock source is RC). Comparator output changes state. Interrupt-on-change. External Interrupt from INT pin. When the SLEEP instruction is being executed, the next instruction (PC + 1) is prefetched. For the device to wake-up through an interrupt event, the corresponding interrupt enable bit must be set (enabled). Wake-up is regardless of the state of the GIE bit. If the GIE bit is clear (disabled), the device continues execution at the instruction after the SLEEP instruction. If the GIE bit is set (enabled), the device executes the instruction after the SLEEP instruction, then branches to the interrupt address (0004h). In cases where the execution of the instruction following SLEEP is not desirable, the user should have a NOP after the SLEEP instruction. Note: If the global interrupts are disabled (GIE is cleared) and any interrupt source has both its interrupt enable bit and the corresponding interrupt flag bits set, the device will immediately wake-up from Sleep. The WDT is cleared when the device wakes up from Sleep, regardless of the source of wake-up. 19.7.2 WAKE-UP USING INTERRUPTS When global interrupts are disabled (GIE cleared) and any interrupt source has both its interrupt enable bit and interrupt flag bit set, one of the following will occur: • If the interrupt occurs before the execution of a SLEEP instruction, the SLEEP instruction will complete as a NOP. Therefore, the WDT and WDT prescaler and postscaler (if enabled) will not be cleared, the TO bit will not be set and the PD bit will not be cleared. • If the interrupt occurs during or after the execution of a SLEEP instruction, the device will Immediately wake-up from Sleep. The SLEEP instruction is executed. Therefore, the WDT and WDT prescaler and postscaler (if enabled) will be cleared, the TO bit will be set and the PD bit will be cleared. Even if the flag bits were checked before executing a SLEEP instruction, it may be possible for flag bits to become set before the SLEEP instruction completes. To determine whether a SLEEP instruction executed, test the PD bit. If the PD bit is set, the SLEEP instruction was executed as a NOP. To ensure that the WDT is cleared, a CLRWDT instruction should be executed before a SLEEP instruction. See Figure 19-10 for more details. Other peripherals cannot generate interrupts since during Sleep, no on-chip clocks are present. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 177 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 19-10: WAKE-UP FROM SLEEP THROUGH INTERRUPT Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 CLKIN TIOSCST CLKOUT INT pin INTF flag (INTCON reg.) Interrupt Latency (3) GIE bit (INTCON reg.) Instruction Flow PC Instruction Fetched Instruction Executed Note 19.8 Processor in Sleep PC Inst(PC) = Sleep Inst(PC – 1) PC + 1 PC + 2 PC + 2 Inst(PC + 1) Inst(PC + 2) Sleep Inst(PC + 1) PC + 2 Dummy Cycle 0004h 0005h Inst(0004h) Inst(0005h) Dummy Cycle Inst(0004h) 1: HFINTOSC Oscillator mode assumed. 2: GIE = ‘1’ assumed. In this case after wake-up, the processor jumps to 0004h. If GIE = ‘0’, execution will continue in-line. Code Protection If the code protection bit(s) have not been programmed, the on-chip program memory can be read out using ICSP™ for verification purposes. Note: 19.9 The entire Flash program memory will be erased when the code protection is turned off. See the “PIC16F753/HV753 Flash Memory Programming Specification” (DS41686) for more information. ID Locations Four memory locations (2000h-2003h) are designated as ID locations where the user can store checksum or other code identification numbers. These locations are not accessible during normal execution but are readable and writable during Program/Verify mode. Only the Least Significant 7 bits of the ID locations are reported when using MPLAB® IDE. DS40001709A-page 178 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 19.10 In-Circuit Serial Programming™ The PIC16F753/HV753 microcontrollers can be serially programmed while in the end application circuit. This is simply done with five connections for: • • • • • clock data power ground programming voltage This allows customers to manufacture boards with unprogrammed devices and then program the microcontroller just before shipping the product. This also allows the most recent firmware or a custom firmware to be programmed. The device is placed into a Program/Verify mode by holding the ICSPDAT and ICSPCLK pins low, while raising the MCLR (VPP) pin from VIL to VIHH. See the “PIC16F753/HV753 Flash Memory Programming Specification” (DS41686) for more information. ICSPDAT becomes the programming data and ICSPCLK becomes the programming clock. Both ICSPDAT and ICSPCLK are Schmitt Trigger inputs in Program/Verify mode. A typical In-Circuit Serial Programming connection is shown in Figure 19-11. FIGURE 19-11: TYPICAL IN-CIRCUIT SERIAL PROGRAMMING CONNECTION To Normal Connections External Connector Signals * PIC16F753/HV753 +5V VDD 0V VSS VPP MCLR/VPP CLK ICSPCLK Data I/O ICSPDAT * * * To Normal Connections * Isolation devices (as required) Note: To erase the device, VDD must be above the Bulk Erase VDD minimum given in the “PIC16F753/HV753 Flash Memory Programming Specification” (DS41686). 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 179 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 180 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 20.0 SHUNT REGULATOR (PIC16HV753 ONLY) The PIC16HV753 devices include a permanent internal 5 volt (nominal) shunt regulator in parallel with the VDD pin. This eliminates the need for an external voltage regulator in systems sourced by an unregulated supply. All external devices connected directly to the VDD pin will share the regulated supply voltage and contribute to the total VDD supply current (ILOAD). 20.1 An external current limiting resistor, RSER, located between the unregulated supply, VUNREG, and the VDD pin, drops the difference in voltage between VUNREG and VDD. RSER must be between RMAX and RMIN as defined by Equation 20-1. EQUATION 20-1: RMAX = RSER LIMITING RESISTOR (VUMIN - 5V) 1.05 • (1 MA + ILOAD) Regulator Operation A shunt regulator generates a specific supply voltage by creating a voltage drop across a pass resistor RSER. The voltage at the VDD pin of the microcontroller is monitored and compared to an internal voltage reference. The current through the resistor is then adjusted, based on the result of the comparison, to produce a voltage drop equal to the difference between the supply voltage VUNREG and the VDD of the microcontroller. See Figure 20-1 for voltage regulator schematic. FIGURE 20-1: RSER ISHUNT ILOAD Feedback RMIN = minimum value of RSER (ohms) VUMIN = minimum value of VUNREG VUMAX = maximum value of VUNREG = regulated voltage (5V nominal) 1.05 = compensation for +5% tolerance of RSER 0.95 = compensation for -5% tolerance of RSER 20.2 VSS Device RMAX = maximum value of RSER (ohms) ILOAD = maximum expected load current in mA including I/O pin currents and external circuits connected to VDD. VDD CBYPASS (VUMAX - 5V) 0.95 • (50 MA) Where: VDD SHUNT REGULATOR VUNREG ISUPPLY RMIN = Regulator Considerations The supply voltage VUNREG and load current are not constant. Therefore, the current range of the regulator is limited. Selecting a value for RSER must take these three factors into consideration. Since the regulator uses the band gap voltage as the regulated voltage reference, this voltage reference is permanently enabled in the PIC16HV753 devices. The shunt regulator will still consume current when below operating voltage range for the shunt regulator. 20.3 Design Considerations For more information on using the shunt regulator and managing current load, see Application Note AN1035, “Designing with HV Microcontrollers” (DS01035). 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 181 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 182 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 21.0 DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT 21.1 The PIC® microcontrollers (MCU) and dsPIC® digital signal controllers (DSC) are supported with a full range of software and hardware development tools: • Integrated Development Environment - MPLAB® X IDE Software • Compilers/Assemblers/Linkers - MPLAB XC Compiler - MPASMTM Assembler - MPLINKTM Object Linker/ MPLIBTM Object Librarian - MPLAB Assembler/Linker/Librarian for Various Device Families • Simulators - MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator • Emulators - MPLAB REAL ICE™ In-Circuit Emulator • In-Circuit Debuggers/Programmers - MPLAB ICD 3 - PICkit™ 3 • Device Programmers - MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer • Low-Cost Demonstration/Development Boards, Evaluation Kits and Starter Kits • Third-party development tools MPLAB X Integrated Development Environment Software The MPLAB X IDE is a single, unified graphical user interface for Microchip and third-party software, and hardware development tool that runs on Windows®, Linux and Mac OS® X. Based on the NetBeans IDE, MPLAB X IDE is an entirely new IDE with a host of free software components and plug-ins for highperformance application development and debugging. Moving between tools and upgrading from software simulators to hardware debugging and programming tools is simple with the seamless user interface. With complete project management, visual call graphs, a configurable watch window and a feature-rich editor that includes code completion and context menus, MPLAB X IDE is flexible and friendly enough for new users. With the ability to support multiple tools on multiple projects with simultaneous debugging, MPLAB X IDE is also suitable for the needs of experienced users. Feature-Rich Editor: • Color syntax highlighting • Smart code completion makes suggestions and provides hints as you type • Automatic code formatting based on user-defined rules • Live parsing User-Friendly, Customizable Interface: • Fully customizable interface: toolbars, toolbar buttons, windows, window placement, etc. • Call graph window Project-Based Workspaces: • • • • Multiple projects Multiple tools Multiple configurations Simultaneous debugging sessions File History and Bug Tracking: • Local file history feature • Built-in support for Bugzilla issue tracker 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 183 PIC16F753/HV753 21.2 MPLAB XC Compilers 21.4 The MPLAB XC Compilers are complete ANSI C compilers for all of Microchip’s 8, 16, and 32-bit MCU and DSC devices. These compilers provide powerful integration capabilities, superior code optimization and ease of use. MPLAB XC Compilers run on Windows, Linux or MAC OS X. For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide debug information that is optimized to the MPLAB X IDE. The free MPLAB XC Compiler editions support all devices and commands, with no time or memory restrictions, and offer sufficient code optimization for most applications. MPLAB XC Compilers include an assembler, linker and utilities. The assembler generates relocatable object files that can then be archived or linked with other relocatable object files and archives to create an executable file. MPLAB XC Compiler uses the assembler to produce its object file. Notable features of the assembler include: • • • • • • Support for the entire device instruction set Support for fixed-point and floating-point data Command-line interface Rich directive set Flexible macro language MPLAB X IDE compatibility 21.3 MPASM Assembler The MPASM Assembler is a full-featured, universal macro assembler for PIC10/12/16/18 MCUs. The MPASM Assembler generates relocatable object files for the MPLINK Object Linker, Intel® standard HEX files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines and generated machine code, and COFF files for debugging. The MPASM Assembler features include: MPLINK Object Linker/ MPLIB Object Librarian The MPLINK Object Linker combines relocatable objects created by the MPASM Assembler. It can link relocatable objects from precompiled libraries, using directives from a linker script. The MPLIB Object Librarian manages the creation and modification of library files of precompiled code. When a routine from a library is called from a source file, only the modules that contain that routine will be linked in with the application. This allows large libraries to be used efficiently in many different applications. The object linker/library features include: • Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many smaller files • Enhanced code maintainability by grouping related modules together • Flexible creation of libraries with easy module listing, replacement, deletion and extraction 21.5 MPLAB Assembler, Linker and Librarian for Various Device Families MPLAB Assembler produces relocatable machine code from symbolic assembly language for PIC24, PIC32 and dsPIC DSC devices. MPLAB XC Compiler uses the assembler to produce its object file. The assembler generates relocatable object files that can then be archived or linked with other relocatable object files and archives to create an executable file. Notable features of the assembler include: • • • • • • Support for the entire device instruction set Support for fixed-point and floating-point data Command-line interface Rich directive set Flexible macro language MPLAB X IDE compatibility • Integration into MPLAB X IDE projects • User-defined macros to streamline assembly code • Conditional assembly for multipurpose source files • Directives that allow complete control over the assembly process DS40001709A-page 184 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 21.6 MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator The MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator allows code development in a PC-hosted environment by simulating the PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs on an instruction level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from a comprehensive stimulus controller. Registers can be logged to files for further run-time analysis. The trace buffer and logic analyzer display extend the power of the simulator to record and track program execution, actions on I/O, most peripherals and internal registers. The MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator fully supports symbolic debugging using the MPLAB XC Compilers, and the MPASM and MPLAB Assemblers. The software simulator offers the flexibility to develop and debug code outside of the hardware laboratory environment, making it an excellent, economical software development tool. 21.7 MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System The MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System is Microchip’s next generation high-speed emulator for Microchip Flash DSC and MCU devices. It debugs and programs all 8, 16 and 32-bit MCU, and DSC devices with the easy-to-use, powerful graphical user interface of the MPLAB X IDE. The emulator is connected to the design engineer’s PC using a high-speed USB 2.0 interface and is connected to the target with either a connector compatible with in-circuit debugger systems (RJ-11) or with the new high-speed, noise tolerant, LowVoltage Differential Signal (LVDS) interconnection (CAT5). The emulator is field upgradable through future firmware downloads in MPLAB X IDE. MPLAB REAL ICE offers significant advantages over competitive emulators including full-speed emulation, run-time variable watches, trace analysis, complex breakpoints, logic probes, a ruggedized probe interface and long (up to three meters) interconnection cables. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. 21.8 MPLAB ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger System The MPLAB ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger System is Microchip’s most cost-effective, high-speed hardware debugger/programmer for Microchip Flash DSC and MCU devices. It debugs and programs PIC Flash microcontrollers and dsPIC DSCs with the powerful, yet easy-to-use graphical user interface of the MPLAB IDE. The MPLAB ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger probe is connected to the design engineer’s PC using a highspeed USB 2.0 interface and is connected to the target with a connector compatible with the MPLAB ICD 2 or MPLAB REAL ICE systems (RJ-11). MPLAB ICD 3 supports all MPLAB ICD 2 headers. 21.9 PICkit 3 In-Circuit Debugger/ Programmer The MPLAB PICkit 3 allows debugging and programming of PIC and dsPIC Flash microcontrollers at a most affordable price point using the powerful graphical user interface of the MPLAB IDE. The MPLAB PICkit 3 is connected to the design engineer’s PC using a fullspeed USB interface and can be connected to the target via a Microchip debug (RJ-11) connector (compatible with MPLAB ICD 3 and MPLAB REAL ICE). The connector uses two device I/O pins and the Reset line to implement in-circuit debugging and In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™). 21.10 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer The MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer is a universal, CE compliant device programmer with programmable voltage verification at VDDMIN and VDDMAX for maximum reliability. It features a large LCD display (128 x 64) for menus and error messages, and a modular, detachable socket assembly to support various package types. The ICSP cable assembly is included as a standard item. In Stand-Alone mode, the MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer can read, verify and program PIC devices without a PC connection. It can also set code protection in this mode. The MPLAB PM3 connects to the host PC via an RS-232 or USB cable. The MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and optimized algorithms for quick programming of large memory devices, and incorporates an MMC card for file storage and data applications. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 185 PIC16F753/HV753 21.11 Demonstration/Development Boards, Evaluation Kits, and Starter Kits 21.12 Third-Party Development Tools A wide variety of demonstration, development and evaluation boards for various PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs allows quick application development on fully functional systems. Most boards include prototyping areas for adding custom circuitry and provide application firmware and source code for examination and modification. The boards support a variety of features, including LEDs, temperature sensors, switches, speakers, RS-232 interfaces, LCD displays, potentiometers and additional EEPROM memory. Microchip also offers a great collection of tools from third-party vendors. These tools are carefully selected to offer good value and unique functionality. • Device Programmers and Gang Programmers from companies, such as SoftLog and CCS • Software Tools from companies, such as Gimpel and Trace Systems • Protocol Analyzers from companies, such as Saleae and Total Phase • Demonstration Boards from companies, such as MikroElektronika, Digilent® and Olimex • Embedded Ethernet Solutions from companies, such as EZ Web Lynx, WIZnet and IPLogika® The demonstration and development boards can be used in teaching environments, for prototyping custom circuits and for learning about various microcontroller applications. In addition to the PICDEM™ and dsPICDEM™ demonstration/development board series of circuits, Microchip has a line of evaluation kits and demonstration software for analog filter design, KEELOQ® security ICs, CAN, IrDA®, PowerSmart battery management, SEEVAL® evaluation system, Sigma-Delta ADC, flow rate sensing, plus many more. Also available are starter kits that contain everything needed to experience the specified device. This usually includes a single application and debug capability, all on one board. Check the Microchip web page (www.microchip.com) for the complete list of demonstration, development and evaluation kits. DS40001709A-page 186 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 22.0 ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS Absolute Maximum Ratings(†) Ambient temperature under bias..........................................................................................................-40° to +125°C Storage temperature ........................................................................................................................ -65°C to +150°C Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ................................................................................................... -0.3V to +6.5V Voltage on MCLR with respect to Vss ............................................................................................... -0.3V to +13.5V Voltage on all other pins with respect to VSS ........................................................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V) Total power dissipation(1) ............................................................................................................................... 800 mW Maximum current out of VSS pin ...................................................................................................................... 95 mA Maximum current into VDD pin ......................................................................................................................... 95 mA Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD)20 mA Output clamp current, IOK (Vo < 0 or Vo >VDD)20 mA Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin.................................................................................................25 mA(2) Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin ...........................................................................................25 mA(2) Maximum current sunk by PORTA................................................................................................................... 90 mA Maximum current sourced PORTA .................................................................................................................. 90 mA Note 1: 2: Power dissipation is calculated as follows: PDIS = VDD x {IDD – IOH} + {(VDD – VOH) x IOH} + (VOl x IOL). 50 mA for RA0 and RA2. † NOTICE: Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure above maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 187 PIC16F753/HV753 PIC16F753 VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH, -40°C TA +125°C FIGURE 22-1: 5.5 5.0 VDD (V) 4.5 4.0 3.5 3.0 2.5 2.0 0 8 10 20 Frequency (MHz) Note 1: The shaded region indicates the permissible combinations of voltage and frequency. PIC16HV753 VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH, -40°C TA +125°C FIGURE 22-2: 5.0 VDD (V) 4.5 4.0 3.5 3.0 2.5 2.0 0 8 10 20 Frequency (MHz) Note 1: The shaded region indicates the permissible combinations of voltage and frequency. D40001709A-page 188 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 22.1 DC Characteristics: PIC16F753/HV753-I (Industrial) PIC16F753/HV753-E (Extended) DC CHARACTERISTICS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for industrial -40°C TA +125°C for extended Param. No. Min. Typ† Max. Units Sym. Characteristic Conditions Supply Voltage D001 VDD PIC16F753 2.0 — 5.5 (2) 5.0 V FOSC < = 4 MHz D001 PIC16HV753 2.0 — D001B VDD PIC16F753 2.0 — 5.5 V FOSC < = 4 MHz V FOSC < = 8 MHz D001B PIC16HV753 2.0 — 5.0(2) V FOSC < = 8 MHz D001C VDD PIC16F753 3.0 — 5.5 V FOSC < = 10 MHz D001C PIC16HV753 3.0 — 5.0(2) V FOSC < = 10 MHz D001D VDD PIC16F753 4.5 — 5.5 V FOSC < = 20 MHz D001D PIC16HV753 4.5 — 5.0(2) V FOSC < = 20 MHz D002* VDR RAM Data Retention Voltage(1) 1.5 — — V Device in Sleep mode D003 VPOR VDD Start Voltage to ensure internal Power-on Reset signal — VSS — V See Table 19-1 for details D004* SVDD VDD Rise Rate to ensure internal Power-on Reset signal 0.05 — — V/ms See Table 19-1 for details * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered in Sleep mode without losing RAM data. 2: On the PIC16HV753, VDD is regulated by a Shunt Regulator and is dependent on series resistor (connected between the unregulated supply voltage and the VDD pin) to limit the current to 50 mA. See Section 20.0 “Shunt Regulator (PIC16HV753 Only)” for design requirements. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 189 PIC16F753/HV753 22.2 DC Characteristics: PIC16F753-I (Industrial) PIC16F753-E (Extended) Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for industrial -40°C TA +125°C for extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param. No. D010 Device Characteristics Supply Current (IDD) PIC16F753 D011* D012* D013* D014 D015 D016 (1, 2) Min. Typ† Max. Units Conditions Note VDD — 8 TBD A 2.0 — 16 TBD A 3.0 — 31 TBD A 5.0 — 140 TBD A 2.0 — 215 TBD A 3.0 — 360 TBD A 5.0 — 185 TBD A 2.0 — 325 TBD A 3.0 — 665 TBD A 5.0 — 270 TBD A 2.0 — 390 TBD A 3.0 — 680 TBD A 5.0 — 0.395 TBD mA 2.0 — 0.620 TBD mA 3.0 — 1.2 TBD mA 5.0 — 2.6 TBD mA 4.5 — 2.8 TBD mA 5.0 — 65 — A 2.0 — 120 — A 3.0 — 250 — A 5.0 FOSC = 31 kHz LFINTOSC FOSC = 1 MHz HFINTOSC FOSC = 4 MHz EC Oscillator FOSC = 4 MHz HFINTOSC FOSC = 8 MHz HFINTOSC FOSC = 20 MHz EC Oscillator FOSC = 1 MHz EC Oscillator Legend: TBD = To Be Determined * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are: CLKIN = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD; MCLR = VDD; WDT disabled. 2: The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on the current consumption. D40001709A-page 190 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 22.3 DC Characteristics: PIC16HV753-I (Industrial) PIC16HV753-E (Extended) Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for industrial -40°C TA +125°C for extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param. No. D010 Device Characteristics Conditions Min. Typ† Max. Units (1,2,3) — 20 TBD A 2.0 PIC16HV753 — 40 TBD A 3.0 Supply Current (IDD) D011* D012* Note VDD — 65 TBD A 4.5 — 215 TBD A 2.0 — 375 TBD A 3.0 — 570 TBD A 4.5 — 335 TBD A 2.0 — 535 TBD A 3.0 FOSC = 31 kHz LFINTOSC FOSC = 1 MHz HFINTOSC Oscillator FOSC = 4 MHz HFINTOSC — 795 TBD A 4.5 — 0.530 TBD mA 2.0 — 0.830 TBD mA 3.0 — 1.35 TBD mA 4.5 D014 — 3.8 TBD mA 4.5 FOSC = 20 MHz EC Oscillator D015 — 130 — A 2.0 FOSC = 1 MHz EC Oscillator D013 D016 — 245 — A 3.0 — 360 — A 5.0 — 250 — A 2.0 — 440 — A 3.0 — 660 — A 5.0 FOSC = 8 MHz HFINTOSC FOSC = 4 MHz EC Oscillator Legend: TBD = To Be Determined * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 4.5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are: CLKIN = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD; MCLR = VDD; WDT disabled. 2: The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on the current consumption. 3: For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can be extended by the formula IR = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in k 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 191 PIC16F753/HV753 22.4 DC Characteristics: PIC16F753-I (Industrial) DC CHARACTERISTICS Param. No. D020 Device Characteristics Power-down Base Current (IPD)(2) PIC16F753 D021 Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for industrial Conditions Min. Typ† Max. Units — 0.01 TBD A 2.0 — 0.3 TBD A 3.0 0.5 TBD A 5.0 150 TBD nA 3.0 -40°C TA +25°C for industrial — 3.0 TBD A 2.0 WDT Current(1) — 4.0 TBD A 3.0 — 7.0 TBD A 5.0 — 5.0 TBD A 3.0 — 6.0 TBD A 5.0 D023 — 362 TBD A 2.0 D025 D026 D027 WDT, BOR, Comparator, VREF and T1OSC disabled — D022 D024 Note VDD BOR Current(1) CxSP = 1, Comparator Current(1), single comparator enabled — 418 TBD A 3.0 — 500 TBD A 5.0 — 96 TBD A 2.0 — 112 TBD A 3.0 — 132 TBD A 5.0 — 0.3 TBD A 3.0 — 0.36 TBD A 5.0 A/D Current(1), no conversion in progress — 0.2 TBD A 3.0 DAC Current(1) — 0.4 TBD A 5.0 — 59 TBD A 3.0 — 98 TBD A 5.0 CxSP = 0, Comparator Current(1), single comparator enabled FVR Current(1), FVRBUFEN = 1, REFOUT buffer enabled Legend: TBD = To Be Determined * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: The peripheral current is the sum of the base IDD or IPD and the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. The peripheral current can be determined by subtracting the base IDD or IPD current from this limit. Max values should be used when calculating total current consumption. 2: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD. D40001709A-page 192 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 22.5 DC Characteristics: PIC16F753-E (Extended) DC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. D020E Device Characteristics Power-down Base Current (IPD)(2) PIC16F753 D021E D022E D023E D024E D025E D026E D027E Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +125°C for extended Min. Typ† Max. Units Conditions VDD Note WDT, BOR, Comparator, DAC and FVR disabled — 0.1 TBD A 2.0 — 0.3 TBD A 3.0 — 0.5 TBD A 5.0 — 3.0 TBD A 2.0 — 4.0 TBD A 3.0 — 7.0 TBD A 5.0 — 5.0 TBD A 3.0 — 6.0 TBD A 5.0 — 362 TBD A 2.0 — 418 TBD A 3.0 WDT Current(1) BOR Current(1) CxSP = 1, Comparator Current(1), single comparator enabled — 500 TBD A 5.0 — 96 TBD A 2.0 — 112 TBD A 3.0 — 132 TBD A 5.0 — .03 TBD A 3.0 — 0.36 TBD A 5.0 A/D Current(1), no conversion in progress — 0.2 TBD A 3.0 DAC Current(1,3) — 0.4 TBD A 5.0 — 59 TBD A 3.0 — 98 TBD A 5.0 CxSP = 0, Comparator Current(1), single comparator enabled FVR Current(1), FVRBUFEN = 1, REFOUT buffer enabled Legend: TBD = To Be Determined * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: The peripheral current is the sum of the base IDD or IPD and the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. The peripheral current can be determined by subtracting the base IDD or IPD current from this limit. Max values should be used when calculating total current consumption. 2: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD. 3: Both or one input reference are in high-Z state. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 193 PIC16F753/HV753 22.6 DC Characteristics: PIC16HV753-I (Industrial) DC CHARACTERISTICS Param. No. D020 Device Characteristics Power-down Base Current (IPD)(2,3) PIC16HV753 D021 D022 D023 D024 D025 D026 D027 Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for industrial Conditions Min. Typ† Max. Units — 135 TBD A 2.0 — 210 TBD A 3.0 Note VDD WDT, BOR, Comparator, DAC and FVR disabled — 260 TBD A 4.5 — 135 TBD A 2.0 — 210 TBD A 3.0 — 265 TBD A 4.5 — 215 TBD A 3.0 — 265 TBD A 4.5 — 362 TBD A 2.0 — 418 TBD A 3.0 — 450 TBD A 4.5 — 90 TBD A 2.0 — 107 TBD A 3.0 — 127 TBD A 4.5 — 210 TBD A 3.0 — 260 TBD A 4.5 A/D Current(1), no conversion in progress — 215 TBD A 3.0 DAC Current(1) — 265 TBD A 4.5 — 485 TBD A 3.0 — 615 TBD A 4.5 WDT Current(1) BOR Current(1) CxSP = 1, Comparator Current(1), single comparator enabled CxSP = 0, Comparator Current(1), single comparator enabled FVR Current(1), FVRBUFEN = 1, REFOUT buffer enabled Legend: TBD = To Be Determined * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 4.5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: The peripheral current is the sum of the base IDD or IPD and the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. The peripheral current can be determined by subtracting the base IDD or IPD current from this limit. Max values should be used when calculating total current consumption. 2: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD. 3: Shunt regulator is always on and always draws operating current. D40001709A-page 194 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 22.7 DC Characteristics: PIC16HV753-E (Extended) DC CHARACTERISTICS Param. No. D020E Device Characteristics Power-down Base Current (IPD)(2,3) PIC16HV753 D021E Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +125°C for extended Min. Typ† Max. Units — 135 TBD A Conditions VDD 2.0 — 210 TBD A 3.0 — 260 TBD A 4.5 — 135 TBD A 2.0 — 210 TBD A 3.0 — 265 TBD A 4.5 D022E — 215 TBD A 3.0 — 265 TBD A 4.5 D023E — 185 TBD A 2.0 D024E — 265 TBD A 3.0 — 320 TBD A 4.5 — 90 TBD A 2.0 — 107 TBD A 3.0 Note WDT, BOR, Comparator, DAC and FVR disabled WDT Current(1) BOR Current(1) CxSP = 1, Comparator Current(1), single comparator enabled CxSP = 0, Comparator Current(1), single comparator enabled — 127 TBD A 4.5 D025E — 210 TBD A 3.0 — 260 TBD A 4.5 A/D Current(1), no conversion in progress D026E — 215 TBD A 3.0 DAC Current(1) — 265 TBD A 4.5 D027E — 485 TBD A 3.0 — 615 TBD A 4.5 FVR Current(1), FVRBUFEN = 1, REFOUT buffer enabled Legend: TBD = To Be Determined * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 4.5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: The peripheral current is the sum of the base IDD or IPD and the additional current consumed when this peripheral is enabled. The peripheral current can be determined by subtracting the base IDD or IPD current from this limit. Max values should be used when calculating total current consumption. 2: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD. 3: Shunt regulator is always on and always draws operating current. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 195 PIC16F753/HV753 22.8 DC Characteristics: PIC16F753/HV753-I (Industrial) PIC16F753/HV753-E (Extended) Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for industrial -40°C TA +125°C for extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param. No. Sym. VIL Characteristic Min. Typ† Max. Units Vss Vss Conditions — 0.8 V 4.5V VDD 5.5V — 0.15 VDD V 2.0V VDD 4.5V Vss — 0.2 VDD V 2.0V VDD 5.5V 2.0 — VDD V 4.5V VDD 5.5V 0.25 VDD + 0.8 — VDD V 2.0V VDD 4.5V 0.8 VDD — VDD V 2.0V VDD 5.5V 0.8 VDD — VDD V Input Low Voltage I/O port: D030 with TTL buffer D030A D031 with Schmitt Trigger buffer VIH Input High Voltage I/O ports: D040 with TTL buffer D040A D041 with Schmitt Trigger buffer D042 MCLR — Input Leakage Current(1,2) IIL D060 I/O ports — 0.1 1 A VSS VPIN VDD, Pin at high-impedance D061 RA3/MCLR(2,3) — 0.7 5 A VSS VPIN VDD — 0.1 5 A EC Configuration 50 250 400 A VDD = 5.0V, VPIN = VSS — — 0.6 V — — 0.6 V IOL = 7.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40°C to +125°C IOL = 8.5 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40°C to +85°C — — 0.6 V — — 0.6 V VDD – 0.7 — — V VDD – 0.7 — — V VDD – 0.7 — — V VDD – 0.7 — — V D063 D070* IPUR PORTA Weak Pull-up Current(4) D080 VOL Output Low Voltage I/O ports (excluding RA0, RA2) RA0, RA2 D090 VOH Output High Voltage I/O ports(1) (excluding RA0, RA2) RA0, RA2 * † Note 1: 2: 3: 4: IOL = 14 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40°C to +125°C IOL = 17 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40°C to +85°C IOH = -2.5 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40°C to +125°C IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40°C to +85°C IOH = -5.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40°C to +125°C IOH = -6.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V, -40°C to +85°C These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin. The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input voltages. This specification applies to RA3/MCLR configured as RA3 with the internal weak pull-up disabled. This specification applies to all weak pull-up pins, including the weak pull-up found on RA3/MCLR. When RA3/MCLR is configured as MCLR Reset pin, the weak pull-up is always enabled. D40001709A-page 196 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 22.8 DC Characteristics: PIC16F753/HV753-I (Industrial) PIC16F753/HV753-E (Extended) (Continued) Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +85°C for industrial -40°C TA +125°C for extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param. No. Sym. Characteristic Min. Typ† Max. Units — — 50 pF Conditions Capacitive Loading Specs on D101* CIO All I/O pins Program Flash Memory D130 EP Cell Endurance 10K 100K — E/W -40°C TA +85°C D130A ED Cell Endurance 1K 10K — E/W +85°C TA +125°C D131 VPR VDD for Read VMIN — 5.5 V D132 VPEW VDD for Bulk Erase/Write 4.5 — 5.5 V D132A VPEW VDD for Row Erase/Write VMIN — 5.5 V D133 TPEW Erase/Write cycle time — 2 2.5 ms D134 TRETD Characteristic Retention 40 — — * † Note 1: 2: 3: 4: VMIN = Minimum operating voltage Year Provided no other specifications are violated These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin. The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input voltages. This specification applies to RA3/MCLR configured as RA3 with the internal weak pull-up disabled. This specification applies to all weak pull-up pins, including the weak pull-up found on RA3/MCLR. When RA3/MCLR is configured as MCLR Reset pin, the weak pull-up is always enabled. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 197 PIC16F753/HV753 22.9 Thermal Considerations Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. No. Sym. Characteristic Typ. Units 84.6* 149.5* 60* 41.2* 39.9* 9* 150* — — C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C/W C W W — — W W Conditions TH01 JA Thermal Resistance Junction to Ambient TH02 JC Thermal Resistance Junction to Case TH03 TH04 TH05 TDIE Die Temperature PD Power Dissipation PINTERNAL Internal Power Dissipation TH06 TH07 PI/O PDER * Note 1: 2: These parameters are characterized but not tested. IDD is current to run the chip alone without driving any load on the output pins. TA = Ambient temperature. D40001709A-page 198 I/O Power Dissipation Derated Power Preliminary 8-pin PDIP package 8-pin SOIC package 8-pin DFN 3x3mm package 8-pin PDIP package 8-pin SOIC package 8-pin DFN 3x3mm package PD = PINTERNAL + PI/O PINTERNAL = IDD x VDD (NOTE 1) PI/O = (IOL * VOL) + (IOH * (VDD - VOH)) PDER = PDMAX (TDIE - TA)/JA (NOTE 2) 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 22.10 Timing Parameter Symbology The timing parameter symbols have been created with one of the following formats: 1. TppS2ppS 2. TppS T F Frequency Lowercase letters (pp) and their meanings: pp cc CCP1 ck CLKOUT cs CS di SDI do SDO dt Data in io I/O Port mc MCLR Uppercase letters and their meanings: S F Fall H High I Invalid (High-Impedance) L Low FIGURE 22-3: T Time osc rd rw sc ss t0 t1 wr OSC1 RD RD or WR SCK SS T0CKI T1CKI WR P R V Z Period Rise Valid High-Impedance LOAD CONDITIONS Load Condition Pin CL VSS Legend: CL=50 pF for all pins 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 199 PIC16F753/HV753 22.11 AC Characteristics: PIC16F753/HV753 (Industrial, Extended) FIGURE 22-4: CLOCK TIMING Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 CLKIN OS02 OS04 OS04 OS03 CLKOUT CLKOUT (CLKOUT Mode) TABLE 22-1: CLOCK OSCILLATOR TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. No. OS01 OS02 Sym. FOSC TOSC Characteristic External CLKIN Frequency(1) (1) External CLKIN Period Min. Typ† Max. Units Conditions DC — 20 MHz EC Oscillator 50 — ns EC Oscillator TCY Instruction Cycle Time(1) 200 TCY DC ns TCY = 4/FOSC * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at “min” values with an external clock applied to CLKIN pin. When an external clock input is used, the “max” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock) for all devices. OS03 D40001709A-page 200 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 22-2: OSCILLATOR PARAMETERS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. No. Sym. Characteristic OS06 TWARM Internal Oscillator Switch when running(2) OS07 INTOSC Internal Calibrated INTOSC Frequency(1) (4 MHz) OS08 INTOSC OS10* Internal Calibrated INTOSC Frequency(1) (8 MHz) TIOSC ST INTOSC Oscillator Wakeup from Sleep Start-up Time Legend: * † Note 1: 2: Freq. Tolerance Min. Typ† Max. Units — — — 2 TOSC Slowest clock 1% 3.96 4.0 4.04 MHz VDD = 3.5V, TA = 25°C 2% 3.92 4.0 4.08 MHz 2.5V VDD 5.5V, 0°C TA +85°C 5% 3.80 4.0 4.2 MHz 2.0V VDD 5.5V, -40°C TA +85°C (Ind.), -40°C TA +125°C (Ext.) 1% 7.92 8.0 8.08 MHz VDD = 3.5V, TA = 25°C 2% 7.84 8.0 8.16 MHz 2.5V VDD 5.5V, 0°C TA +85°C 5% 7.60 8.0 8.40 MHz 2.0V VDD 5.5V, -40°C TA +85°C (Ind.), -40°C TA +125°C (Ext.) — TBD 12 TBD s VDD = 2.0V, -40°C to +85°C — TBD 7 TBD s VDD = 3.0V, -40°C to +85°C — TBD 6 TBD s VDD = 5.0V, -40°C to +85°C Conditions TBD = To Be Determined These parameters are characterized but not tested. Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. To ensure these oscillator frequency tolerances, VDD and VSS must be capacitively decoupled as close to the device as possible. 0.1 F and 0.01 F values in parallel are recommended. By design. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 201 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 22-5: CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING Cycle Write Fetch Read Execute Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 FOSC OS20 CLKOUT OS21 OS19 OS18 OS16 OS13 OS17 I/O pin (Input) OS14 OS15 I/O pin (Output) New Value Old Value OS18, OS19 TABLE 22-3: CLKOUT AND I/O TIMING PARAMETERS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. No. OS13 Sym. TCKL2IOV Characteristic Min. CLKOUT to Port out valid(2) CLKOUT(2) — Typ† Max. Units — 20 Conditions ns OS14 TIOV2CKH Port input valid before TOSC + 200 ns — — ns OS15 TOSH2IOV FOSC (Q1 cycle) to Port out valid — 50 70* ns VDD = 5.0V OS16 TOSH2IOI FOSC (Q2 cycle) to Port input invalid (I/O in hold time) 50 — — ns VDD = 5.0V OS17 TIOV2OSH Port input valid to FOSC(Q2 cycle) (I/O in setup time) 20 — — ns OS18 TIOR Port output rise time(2) — — 15 40 72 32 ns VDD = 2.0V VDD = 5.0V OS19 TIOF Port output fall time(2) — — 28 15 55 30 ns VDD = 2.0V VDD = 5.0V OS20* TINP INT pin input high or low time 25 — — ns TCY(1) — — ns OS21* TRAP PORTA interrupt-on-change new input level time * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25C unless otherwise stated. Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at “min” values with an external clock applied to the CLKIN pin. When an external clock input is used, the “max” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock) for all devices. 2: Includes CLKOUTEN = 0, CLKOUT function enabled. D40001709A-page 202 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 22-6: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, AND POWER-UP TIMER TIMING VDD MCLR 30 Internal POR 33 PWRT Time-out 32 OSC Start-Up Time Internal Reset(1) Watchdog Timer Reset(1) 31 34 34 I/O pins Note 1: FIGURE 22-7: Asserted low. BROWN-OUT RESET TIMING AND CHARACTERISTICS VDD VBOR + VHYST VBOR (Device in Brown-out Reset) (Device not in Brown-out Reset) 37 Reset (due to BOR) * 33* 64 ms delay only if PWRTE bit in the Configuration Word register is programmed to ‘0’. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 203 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 22-4: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER AND BROWN-OUT RESET PARAMETERS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. No. Sym. Characteristic Min. Typ† Max. Units Conditions 30 TMCL MCLR Pulse Width (low) 2 5 — — — — s s VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C VDD = 5V, -40°C to +125°C 31* TWDT Watchdog Timer Time-out Period (No Prescaler) 10 10 20 20 TBD TBD ms ms VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C VDD = 5V, -40°C to +125°C 32* TPWRT Power-up Timer Period 40 65 140 ms 33* TIOZ I/O High-impedance from MCLR Low or Watchdog Timer Reset — — 2.0 s 34 VBOR Brown-out Reset Voltage 2.0 2.15 2.3 V 35* VHYST Brown-out Reset Hysteresis — 100 — mV 36* TBOR Brown-out Reset Minimum Detection Period 100 — — s (NOTE 1) VDD VBOR Legend: TBD = To Be Determined * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: To ensure these voltage tolerances, VDD and VSS must be capacitively decoupled as close to the device as possible. 0.1 F and 0.01 F values in parallel are recommended. D40001709A-page 204 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 22-8: TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMINGS T0CKI 40 41 42 T1CKI 45 46 49 47 TMR0 or TMR1 TABLE 22-5: TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. No. Sym. Characteristic 40* TT0H T0CKI High Pulse Width 41* TT0L T0CKI Low Pulse Width 42* TT0P T0CKI Period 45* TT1H 46* TT1L 47* TT1P T1CKI High Synchronous, No Prescaler Time Synchronous, with Prescaler Asynchronous T1CKI Low Synchronous, No Prescaler Time Synchronous, with Prescaler Asynchronous T1CKI Input Synchronous Period 49* No Prescaler With Prescaler No Prescaler With Prescaler Min. Typ† Max. Units 0.5 TCY + 20 10 0.5 TCY + 20 10 Greater of: 20 or TCY + 40 N 0.5 TCY + 20 15 — — — — — — — — — — ns ns ns ns ns — — — — ns ns 30 0.5 TCY + 20 15 30 Greater of: 30 or TCY + 40 N 60 2 TOSC — — — — — — — — — — ns ns ns ns ns Conditions N = prescale value (2, 4, ..., 256) N = prescale value (1, 2, 4, 8) Asynchronous — — ns TCKEZTMR1 Delay from External Clock Edge to Timer — 7 TOSC — Timers in Sync Increment mode * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 205 PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 22-9: PIC16F753/HV753 CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM TIMINGS (CCP) CCP1 (Capture mode) CC01 CC02 CC03 Note: TABLE 22-6: Refer to Figure 22-3 for load conditions. PIC16F753/HV753 CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM REQUIREMENTS (CCP) Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. No. CC01* Sym. Characteristic TccL CC02* CCP1 Input Low Time TccH CC03* CCP1 Input High Time TccP Min. Typ† Max. Units No Prescaler 0.5TCY + 20 — — ns With Prescaler 20 — — ns No Prescaler 0.5TCY + 20 — — ns With Prescaler 20 — — ns 3TCY + 40 N — — ns CCP1 Input Period Conditions N = prescale value (1, 4 or 16) * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. TABLE 22-7: COMPARATOR SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating Temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. No. Sym. Characteristics Min. Typ† Max. Units CM01 VOS Input Offset Voltage(2) — — 5.0 7.0 10 20 mV mV CM02 VCM Input Common Mode Voltage 0 — VDD – 1.5 V CM03* CMRR Common Mode Rejection Ratio CM04* TRT Response Time(1) CM05* TMC2COV Comparator Mode Change to Output Valid CM06* VHYS — CxSP = 1 CxSP = 0 Input Hysteresis Voltage +55 — — dB — 55 TBD ns — 65 TBD ns — — 10 s 20 TBD mV Comments CxSP = 1 CxSP = 0 Legend: TBD = To Be Determined * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Response time is measured with one comparator input at (VDD - 1.5)/2 - 100 mV to (VDD - 1.5)/2 + 20 mV. The other input is at (VDD -1.5)/2. 2: Input offset voltage is measured with one comparator input at (VDD - 1.5V)/2. D40001709A-page 206 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 22-8: DIGITAL-TO-ANALOG (DAC) SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. No. Sym. Characteristics Min. Typ† Max. Units — V DA01* CLSB Step Size — VDD/512 DA02* CACC Absolute Accuracy — 1/2 — LSB DA03* CR Unit Resistor Value (R) — TBD — DA04* CST Settling Time — 10 — s Comments Legend: TBD = To Be Determined * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. TABLE 22-9: FIXED VOLTAGE REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS VR Voltage Reference Specifications Param. No. Symbol Characteristics Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +125°C Min. Typ. Max. Units VR01* VFVR FVR Voltage Output — 1.2 — V VR02* TSTABLE FVR Turn On Time — 200 — s * Comments These parameters are characterized but not tested. TABLE 22-10: SHUNT REGULATOR SPECIFICATIONS (PIC16HV753 only) SHUNT REGULATOR CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol No. Characteristics SR01 VSHUNT Shunt Voltage SR02 ISHUNT SR03* TSETTLE Settling Time SR04 CLOAD Load Capacitance SR05 ISNT Regulator operating current * Shunt Current Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +125°C Min. Typ. Max. Units Comments 4.75 5 5.4 V 1 — 50 mA — — 150 ns To 1% of final value 0.01 — 10 F Bypass capacitor on VDD pin — 180 — A Includes band gap reference current These parameters are characterized but not tested. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 207 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 22-11: OPERATIONAL AMPLIFIER SPECIFICATIONS OP AMP CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol No. Characteristics Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature 25°C, High-Power mode, VDD = 5V Min. Typ. Max. Units Gain bandwidth product — 3 — MHz Conditions OPA01 GBWP OPA02 TON Turn on time — 10 — µs OPA03 PM Phase margin — 60 — °C OPA04 SR Slew rate 2 — — V/µs OPA05 OFF Offset — — — mV OPA06 CMRR Common mode rejection ratio — 70 — dB OPA07 AOL Open loop gain — — 90 dB No Load — — 60 dB Standard Load AVDD 1.4V V — dB OPA08 VICM Common mode input range VSS — OPA09 PSRR Power supply rejection ratio 80 — D40001709A-page 208 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 22-12: PIC16F753/HV753 A/D CONVERTER (ADC) CHARACTERISTICS: Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. Sym. No. Characteristic Min. Typ† Max. Units Conditions AD01 NR Resolution — — 10 bits AD02 EIL Integral Error(1) — — 1 LSb VREF = 5.12V(5) AD03 EDL Differential Error(1,2) — — 1 LSb No missing codes to 10 bits VREF = 5.12V(5) AD04 EOFF Offset Error(1) — +1.5 +2.0 LSb VREF = 5.12V(5) AD07 EGN Gain Error(1) — — 1 LSb VREF = 5.12V(5) 2.2 2.5 — — VDD V (3) bit AD06 VREF AD06A Reference Voltage AD07 VAIN Full-Scale Range VSS — VREF V AD08 ZAIN Recommended Impedance of Analog Voltage Source — — 10 k VREF Input Current(3,4) 10 — 1000 A During VAIN acquisition. Based on differential of VHOLD to VAIN. — — 50(4) A During A/D conversion cycle AD09* IREF Absolute minimum to ensure 1 LSb accuracy * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: Total Absolute Error includes integral, differential, offset and gain errors. 2: The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage and has no missing codes. 3: ADC VREF is from external VREF or VDD pin, whichever is selected as reference input. 4: When ADC is off, it will not consume any current other than leakage current. The power-down current specification includes any such leakage from the ADC module. 5: VREF = 5V for PIC16HV753. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary D40001709A-page 209 PIC16F753/HV753 TABLE 22-13: PIC16F753/HV753 A/D CONVERSION REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C TA +125°C Param. Sym. No. Characteristic Min. Typ† 1.6 — 9.0 s TOSC-based, VREF 3.0V 3.0 — 9.0 s TOSC-based, VREF full range(3) 3.0 6.0 9.0 s ADCS<2:0> = 11 At VDD = 2.5V 1.6 4.0 6.0 s At VDD = 5.0V — 11 — TAD Set GO/DONE bit to new data in A/D Result register A/D Clock Period AD130* TAD A/D Internal RC Oscillator Period AD131 TCNV Conversion Time (not including Acquisition Time)(1) AD132* TACQ Acquisition Time(2) AD133* TAMP AD134 TGO Max. Units 11.5 — s Amplifier Settling Time — — 5 s Q4 to A/D Clock Start — TOSC/2 — — Conditions * These parameters are characterized but not tested. † Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. Note 1: ADRESH and ADRESL registers may be read on the following TCY cycle. 2: See Section 12.4 “A/D Acquisition Requirements” for minimum conditions. 3: Full range for PIC16HV753 powered by the shunt regulator is the 5V regulated voltage. FIGURE 22-10: PIC16F753/HV753 A/D CONVERSION TIMING (NORMAL MODE) BSF ADCON0, GO 1 TCY (TOSC/2) AD134 AD131 Q4 AD130 A/D CLK 9 A/D Data 8 7 6 OLD_DATA ADRES 2 1 0 NEW_DATA 1 TCY ADIF GO Sample 3 DONE AD132 D40001709A-page 210 Sampling Stopped Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 FIGURE 22-11: PIC16F753/HV753 A/D CONVERSION TIMING (SLEEP MODE) BSF ADCON0, GO AD134 (TOSC/2 + TCY) 1 TCY AD131 Q4 AD130 A/D CLK 9 A/D Data 8 7 6 OLD_DATA ADRES 3 2 1 0 NEW_DATA ADIF 1 TCY GO DONE Sample AD132 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Sampling Stopped Preliminary D40001709A-page 211 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: D40001709A-page 212 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 23.0 DC AND AC CHARACTERISTICS GRAPHS AND CHARTS Graphs and charts are not available at this time. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 213 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 214 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 24.0 PACKAGING INFORMATION 24.1 Package Marking Information 14-Lead PDIP (300 mil) Example PIC16F753 -I/P 1306017 14-Lead SOIC (3.90 mm) Example PIC16F753 -I/SL 1306017 Legend: XX...X Y YY WW NNN e3 * Note: * Customer-specific information Year code (last digit of calendar year) Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year) Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’) Alphanumeric traceability code Pb-free JEDEC designator for Matte Tin (Sn) This package is Pb-free. The Pb-free JEDEC designator ( can be found on the outer packaging for this package. ) e3 In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available characters for customer-specific information. Standard PIC device marking consists of Microchip part number, year code, week code, and traceability code. For PIC device marking beyond this, certain price adders apply. Please check with your Microchip Sales Office. For QTP devices, any special marking adders are included in QTP price. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 215 PIC16F753/HV753 24.2 Package Marking Information 14-Lead TSSOP (4.4 mm) Example XXXXXXXX YYWW NNN 753/ST 1306 017 16-Lead QFN (4x4x0.9 mm) Example PIN 1 PIN 1 PIC16 F753 -I/ML 306017 Legend: XX...X Y YY WW NNN e3 * Note: * Customer-specific information Year code (last digit of calendar year) Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year) Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’) Alphanumeric traceability code Pb-free JEDEC designator for Matte Tin (Sn) This package is Pb-free. The Pb-free JEDEC designator ( can be found on the outer packaging for this package. ) e3 In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available characters for customer-specific information. Standard PIC device marking consists of Microchip part number, year code, week code, and traceability code. For PIC device marking beyond this, certain price adders apply. Please check with your Microchip Sales Office. For QTP devices, any special marking adders are included in QTP price. DS40001709A-page 216 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 24.3 Package Details The following sections give the technical details of the packages. 3 %& %!%4") ' % 4$% %"% %%255)))& &54 N NOTE 1 E1 1 3 2 D E A2 A L A1 c b1 b e eB 6% & 9&% 7!&( $ 7+8- 7 7 7: ; % % % < < ""44 0 , 0 1 % % 0 < < !"% !"="% - , ,0 ""4="% - 0 > :9% ,0 0 0 % % 9 0 , 0 9"4 > 0 ( 0 ? ( > 1 < < 69"="% 9 )9"="% : )* 1+ , !"#$%!&'(!%&! %( %")%%%" *$%+% % , & "-" %!"& "$ %! "$ %! %#". " & "% -/0 1+21 & %#%! ))% !%% ) +01 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 217 PIC16F753/HV753 Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging DS40001709A-page 218 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 219 PIC16F753/HV753 3 %& %!%4") ' % 4$% %"% %%255)))& &54 DS40001709A-page 220 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 221 PIC16F753/HV753 Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging DS40001709A-page 222 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 223 PIC16F753/HV753 ! "#$ %&'(()*"# 3 %& %!%4") ' % 4$% %"% %%255)))& &54 D2 D EXPOSED PAD e E2 E 2 2 1 1 b TOP VIEW K N N NOTE 1 L BOTTOM VIEW A3 A A1 6% & 9&% 7!&( $ 99-- 7 7 7: ; ? % :8% > %" $$ 0 + %%4 , :="% - -# ""="% - :9% -# ""9% ?01+ -3 1+ 0 ?0 > 1+ 0 ?0 + %%="% ( 0 , ,0 + %%9% 9 , 0 + %%% -# "" V < !"#$%!&'(!%&! %( %")%%%" 4 ) !%" , & "% -/0 1+2 1 & %#%! ))% !%% -32 $& '! !)% !%% '$ $ &% ! > < ) +1 DS40001709A-page 224 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 225 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 226 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 APPENDIX A: DATA SHEET REVISION HISTORY Revision A (5/2013) Original release of this document. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 227 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 228 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 INDEX A A/D Specifications.................................................... 209, 210 Absolute Maximum Ratings .............................................. 187 AC Characteristics Industrial and Extended ............................................ 200 Load Conditions ........................................................ 199 ADC .................................................................................. 113 Acquisition Requirements ......................................... 121 Associated registers.................................................. 123 Block Diagram........................................................... 113 Calculating Acquisition Time..................................... 121 Channel Selection..................................................... 114 Configuration............................................................. 114 Configuring Interrupt ................................................. 117 Conversion Clock...................................................... 114 Conversion Procedure .............................................. 117 Internal Sampling Switch (RSS) Impedance.............. 121 Interrupts................................................................... 115 Operation .................................................................. 116 Operation During Sleep ............................................ 116 Port Configuration ..................................................... 114 Reference Voltage (VREF)......................................... 114 Result Formatting...................................................... 116 Source Impedance.................................................... 121 Special Event Trigger................................................ 116 Starting an A/D Conversion ...................................... 116 ADCON0 Register............................................................. 118 ADCON1 Register............................................................. 119 ADRESH Register (ADFM = 0) ......................................... 120 ADRESH Register (ADFM = 1) ......................................... 120 ADRESL Register (ADFM = 0).......................................... 120 ADRESL Register (ADFM = 1).......................................... 120 Alternate Pin Function......................................................... 44 Analog-to-Digital Converter. See ADC ANSELA Register ......................................................... 48, 54 APFCON Register............................................................... 44 Assembler MPASM Assembler................................................... 184 B Block Diagrams (CCP) Capture Mode Operation ................................. 81 ADC .......................................................................... 113 ADC Transfer Function ............................................. 122 Analog Input Model ........................................... 122, 138 CCP PWM................................................................... 85 Clock Source............................................................... 37 Compare ..................................................................... 83 Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC)............................ 128 Generic I/O Port .......................................................... 43 HLTMR1...................................................................... 77 In-Circuit Serial Programming Connections.............. 179 Interrupt Logic ........................................................... 172 MCLR Circuit............................................................. 164 On-Chip Reset Circuit ............................................... 163 OPA Module.............................................................. 143 PIC16F753/HV753........................................................ 7 Slope Compensation Module.................................... 145 Timer1....................................................... 63, 68, 69, 70 Timer2......................................................................... 75 TMR0/WDT Prescaler................................................. 59 Voltage Reference .................................................... 125 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Voltage Reference Output Buffer Example .............. 128 Watchdog Timer ....................................................... 175 Brown-out Reset (BOR).................................................... 165 Associated Registers................................................ 166 Specifications ........................................................... 204 Timing and Characteristics ....................................... 203 C C Compilers MPLAB C18.............................................................. 184 Calibration Bits.................................................................. 163 Capture Module. See Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) Capture/Compare/PWM ..................................................... 81 Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) .......................................... 81 Associated Registers w/ Capture ............................... 82 Associated Registers w/ Compare ............................. 84 Capture Mode............................................................. 81 CCP1 Pin Configuration ............................................. 81 Compare Mode........................................................... 83 CCP1 Pin Configuration ..................................... 83 Software Interrupt Mode ............................... 81, 83 Special Event Trigger ......................................... 83 Timer1 Mode Resource ................................ 81, 83 Prescaler .................................................................... 81 PWM Mode Duty Cycle .......................................................... 86 PWM Operation .......................................................... 85 PWM Overview........................................................... 85 PWM Period ............................................................... 86 PWM Setup ................................................................ 86 Specifications ........................................................... 206 CCP. See Capture/Compare/PWM CCP1CON (CCP1) Register............................................... 87 Clock Sources External Modes EC ...................................................................... 38 Internal Modes............................................................ 38 CMOUT Register .............................................................. 140 CMxCON0 Register .......................................................... 139 CMxCON1 Register .......................................................... 140 Code Examples A/D Conversion ........................................................ 117 Assigning Prescaler to Timer0.................................... 60 Assigning Prescaler to WDT....................................... 60 Changing Between Capture Prescalers ..................... 81 Indirect Addressing..................................................... 25 Initializing PORTA ...................................................... 43 Saving Status and W Registers in RAM ................... 174 Writing to Flash Program Memory.............................. 34 Code Protection ................................................................ 178 COG ................................................................................... 89 Associated registers ................................................. 111 COGxASD0 Register ........................................................ 106 COGxASD1 Register ........................................................ 107 COGxBLKF Register ........................................................ 109 COGxBLKR Register ........................................................ 109 COGxCON0 Register ....................................................... 100 COGxCON1 Register ....................................................... 101 COGxDBF Register .......................................................... 108 COGxDBR Register.......................................................... 108 COGxFIS Register............................................................ 104 COGxFSIM Register......................................................... 105 COGxPHF Register .......................................................... 110 COGxPHR Register.......................................................... 110 Preliminary DS40001709A-page 229 PIC16F753/HV753 COGxRIS Register............................................................ 102 COGxRSIM Register......................................................... 103 Comparator ....................................................................... 133 Associated Registers ................................................ 141 Operation .................................................................. 133 Comparator Module .......................................................... 133 Cx Output State Versus Input Conditions ................. 135 Comparators C2OUT as T1 Gate ..................................................... 65 Specifications............................................................ 206 Compare Module. See Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) Complementary Output Generator (COG) .......................... 89 CONFIG1 Register............................................................ 162 Configuration Bits.............................................................. 161 CPU Features ................................................................... 161 Customer Change Notification Service ............................. 233 Customer Notification Service........................................... 233 Customer Support ............................................................. 233 D DACxCON0 (DACx Voltage Reference Control 0) Register..................................................................... 130 DACxREFH Register (DACxFM= 0) ................................. 131 DACxREFH Register (DACxFM= 1) ................................. 132 DACxREFL Register (DACxFM= 0) .................................. 131 DACxREFL Register (DACxFM= 1) .................................. 132 Data Memory....................................................................... 11 DC Characteristics Extended and Industrial ............................................ 196 Industrial and Extended ............................................ 189 Development Support ....................................................... 183 Device Overview ................................................................... 7 Digital-to-Analog (DAC) Specifications............................................................ 207 Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC).................................... 127 Associated Registers ................................................ 132 Effects of a Reset...................................................... 128 E Electrical Specifications .................................................... 187 Errata .................................................................................... 5 F Firmware Instructions........................................................ 151 Fixed Voltage Reference (FVR) Associated Registers ................................................ 126 Specifications............................................................ 207 Flash Program Memory Associated Registers .................................................. 35 Flash Program Memory Self Read/Self Write Control......... 27 FVRCON (Fixed Voltage Reference Control) Register ..... 126 G General Purpose Register File............................................ 11 H Hardware Limit Timer (HLT)................................................ 77 High Temperature Operation ............................................ 211 HLT Associated registers.................................................... 80 HLT1CON0 (HLT1 Control 0) Register ............................... 79 HLT1CON1 (HLT1 Control 1) Register ............................... 80 I ID Locations...................................................................... 178 In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP)............................... 179 Indirect Addressing, INDF and FSR registers..................... 25 Instruction Format............................................................. 151 Instruction Set................................................................... 151 ADDLW..................................................................... 153 ADDWF..................................................................... 153 ANDLW..................................................................... 153 ANDWF..................................................................... 153 BCF .......................................................................... 153 BSF........................................................................... 153 BTFSC ...................................................................... 153 BTFSS ...................................................................... 154 CALL......................................................................... 154 CLRF ........................................................................ 154 CLRW ....................................................................... 154 CLRWDT .................................................................. 154 COMF ....................................................................... 154 DECF ........................................................................ 154 DECFSZ ................................................................... 155 GOTO ....................................................................... 155 INCF ......................................................................... 155 INCFSZ..................................................................... 155 IORLW ...................................................................... 155 IORWF...................................................................... 155 MOVF ....................................................................... 156 MOVLW .................................................................... 156 MOVWF .................................................................... 156 NOP .......................................................................... 156 RETFIE ..................................................................... 157 RETLW ..................................................................... 157 RETURN................................................................... 157 RLF ........................................................................... 158 RRF .......................................................................... 158 SLEEP ...................................................................... 158 SUBLW ..................................................................... 158 SUBWF..................................................................... 159 SWAPF ..................................................................... 159 XORLW .................................................................... 159 XORWF .................................................................... 159 Summary Table ........................................................ 152 INTCON Register................................................................ 19 Internal Oscillator Block INTOSC Specifications ........................................... 201, 202 Internal Sampling Switch (RSS) Impedance...................... 121 Internet Address ............................................................... 233 Interrupts........................................................................... 171 ADC .......................................................................... 117 Associated Registers ................................................ 173 Context Saving ......................................................... 174 Interrupt-on-Change ............................................. 47, 53 PORTA Interrupt-on-Change .................................... 172 RA2/INT .................................................................... 171 Timer0 ...................................................................... 172 TMR1 .......................................................................... 67 INTOSC Specifications ............................................. 201, 202 IOCAF Register ............................................................ 49, 56 IOCAN Register ............................................................ 49, 56 IOCAP Register ............................................................ 49, 55 L LATA Register .............................................................. 46, 52 Load Conditions................................................................ 199 DS40001709A-page 230 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 M MCLR ................................................................................ 164 Internal ...................................................................... 164 Memory Organization.......................................................... 11 Data ............................................................................ 11 Program ...................................................................... 11 Microchip Internet Web Site .............................................. 233 MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker, Librarian ................... 184 MPLAB Integrated Development Environment Software .. 183 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer .................................... 185 MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System................. 185 MPLINK Object Linker/MPLIB Object Librarian ................ 184 O OPCODE Field Descriptions ............................................. 151 Operation During Code Protect........................................... 32 Operation During Write Protect ........................................... 32 Operational Amplifier (OPA) Module................................. 143 AC Specifications...................................................... 207 Associated Registers ................................................ 144 OPTION Register ................................................................ 18 OPTION_REG Register ...................................................... 61 OSCCON Register .............................................................. 40 Oscillator Associated registers.............................................. 41, 73 Oscillator Module .......................................................... 27, 37 Oscillator Parameters ....................................................... 201 Oscillator Specifications.................................................... 200 Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) Specifications............................................................ 204 OSCTUNE Register ............................................................ 41 P Packaging ......................................................................... 215 Marking ............................................................. 215, 216 PDIP Details.............................................................. 216 PCL and PCLATH ............................................................... 25 Stack ........................................................................... 25 PCON Register ........................................................... 24, 166 PIC16F753/HV753 ................................................................ 8 PIE1 Register ...................................................................... 20 PIE2 Register ...................................................................... 21 Pinout Descriptions PIC16F753/HV753........................................................ 8 PIR1 Register...................................................................... 22 PIR2 Register...................................................................... 23 PMADRH and PMADRL Registers ..................................... 27 PMCON1 and PMCON2 Registers ..................................... 27 PMCON1 Register .............................................................. 29 PMDATH Register .............................................................. 28 PMDATL Register ............................................................... 28 PMDRH Register ................................................................ 28 PORTA Additional Pin Functions ............................................. 47 ANSEL Register............................................ 47, 53 Interrupt-on-Change ..................................... 47, 53 Slew Rate Control ......................................... 47, 53 Weak Pull-Ups .............................................. 47, 53 Associated Registers ............................................ 50, 57 RA2 ....................................................................... 50, 57 RA3 ....................................................................... 50, 57 RA4 ....................................................................... 50, 57 Specifications............................................................ 202 PORTA Register ................................................................. 46 Power-Down Mode (Sleep) ............................................... 177 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Power-on Reset (POR)..................................................... 164 Power-up Timer (PWRT) .................................................. 165 Specifications ........................................................... 204 Precision Internal Oscillator Parameters .......................... 202 Prescaler Shared WDT/Timer0................................................... 60 Switching Prescaler Assignment ................................ 60 Program Memory ................................................................ 11 Map and Stack............................................................ 11 Programming, Device Instructions.................................... 151 Protection Against Spurious Write ...................................... 32 PWM (CCP Module) PWM Steering ............................................................ 87 PWM Steering..................................................................... 87 R Reader Response............................................................. 234 Reading the Flash Program Memory.................................. 30 Read-Modify-Write Operations ......................................... 151 Registers ADCON0 (ADC Control 0) ........................................ 118 ADCON1 (ADC Control 1) ........................................ 119 ADRESH (ADC Result High) with ADFM = 0) .......... 120 ADRESH (ADC Result High) with ADFM = 1) .......... 120 ADRESL (ADC Result Low) with ADFM = 0)............ 120 ADRESL (ADC Result Low) with ADFM = 1)............ 120 ANSELA (PORTA Analog Select) ........................ 48, 54 APFCON (Alternate Pin Function Control) ................. 44 CCP1CON (CCP1 Control) ........................................ 87 CMOUT (Comparator Output) .................................. 140 CMxCON0 (Cx Control) ............................................ 139 CMxCON1 (Cx Control 1)......................................... 140 COGxASD0 (COG Auto-Shutdown Control 0) ......... 106 COGxASD1 (COG Auto-Shutdown Control 1) ......... 107 COGxBLKF (COG Falling Event Blanking Count) .... 109 COGxBLKR (COG Rising Event Blanking Count) .... 109 COGxCON0 (COG Control 0) .................................. 100 COGxCON1 (COG Control 1) .................................. 101 COGxDBF (COG Falling Event Dead-Band Count) . 108 COGxDBR (COG Rising Event Dead-Band Count) . 108 COGxFIS (COG Falling Event Input Selection)........ 104 COGxFSIM (COG Falling Event Source Input Mode) ...................................................... 105 COGxPHF (COG Falling Edge Phase Delay Count) 110 COGxPHR (COG Rising Edge Phase Delay Count) 110 COGxRIS (COG Rising Event Input Selection) ........ 102 COGxRSIM (COG Rising Event Source Input Mode) ...................................................... 103 Configuration Word 1................................................ 162 DACxCON0 .............................................................. 130 DACxREFH (DAC Reference High) with DACxFM = 0) ............................................ 131 DACxREFH (DAC Reference High) with DACxFM = 1) ............................................ 132 DACxREFL (DAC Reference Low) with DACxFM = 0) ............................................ 131 DACxREFL (DAC Reference Low) with DACxFM = 1) ............................................ 132 Data Memory Map ...................................................... 12 FVRCON .................................................................. 126 HLT1CON0................................................................. 79 HLT1CON1................................................................. 80 INTCON (Interrupt Control) ........................................ 19 IOCAF (Interrupt-on-Change Flag)....................... 49, 56 IOCAN (Interrupt-on-Change Negative Edge)...... 49, 56 IOCAP (Interrupt-on-Change Positive Edge)........ 49, 55 Preliminary DS40001709A-page 231 PIC16F753/HV753 LATA (Data Latch PORTA) ................................... 46, 52 OPTION_REG (OPTION) ..................................... 18, 61 OSCCON (Oscillator Control) ..................................... 40 OSCTUNE (Oscillator Tuning) .................................... 41 PCON (Power Control) ....................................... 24, 166 PIE1 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 1) ........................... 20 PIE2 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 2) ........................... 21 PIR1 (Peripheral Interrupt Register 1) ........................ 22 PIR2 (Peripheral Interrupt Register 2) ........................ 23 PMCON1 (Program Memory Control 1) ...................... 29 PMDATH (Program Memory Data) ............................. 28 PMDATL (Program Memory Data).............................. 28 PMDRH (Program Memory Address).......................... 28 PORTA........................................................................ 46 Reset Values............................................................. 168 Reset Values (special registers) ............................... 170 SLPCCON0............................................................... 148 SLPCCON1............................................................... 148 Special Function Registers ......................................... 11 STATUS ...................................................................... 17 T1CON (Timer1 Control)............................................. 71 T1GCON (Timer1 Gate Control) ................................. 72 T2CON ........................................................................ 76 TRISA (Tri-State PORTA) ..................................... 46, 52 WPUA (Weak Pull-up PORTA) ............................. 48, 55 Reset................................................................................. 163 Revision History ................................................................ 227 S Shunt Regulator ................................................................ 181 Sleep Power-Down Mode ................................................... 177 Wake-up.................................................................... 177 Wake-up using Interrupts.......................................... 177 Slew Rate Control ......................................................... 47, 53 Slope Compensation (SC) Module.................................... 145 Associated Registers ................................................ 149 Configuration Word w/ the Slope Compensation Module .............................................................. 149 SLPCCON0 (Slope Compensation Control 0) Register .... 148 SLPCCON1 (Slope Compensation Control 1) Register .... 148 Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM)..................................... 185 Special Event Trigger........................................................ 116 Special Function Registers ................................................. 11 STATUS Register................................................................ 17 T T1CON Register.................................................................. 71 T1GCON Register............................................................... 72 T2CON Register.................................................................. 76 Thermal Considerations .................................................... 198 Time-out Sequence........................................................... 166 Timer0 ................................................................................. 59 Associated Registers .................................................. 61 External Clock............................................................. 60 Interrupt....................................................................... 61 Operation .............................................................. 59, 64 Specifications............................................................ 205 T0CKI .......................................................................... 60 Timer1 Associated registers.................................................... 73 Asynchronous Counter Mode ..................................... 65 Reading and Writing ........................................... 65 Interrupt....................................................................... 67 Modes of Operation .................................................... 64 Operation During Sleep .............................................. 67 DS40001709A-page 232 Prescaler .................................................................... 65 Specifications ........................................................... 205 Timer1 Gate Selecting Source ................................................ 65 TMR1H Register ......................................................... 63 TMR1L Register.......................................................... 63 Timer2 Associated registers ............................................. 76, 80 Timers HLT HLT1CON0......................................................... 79 HLT1CON1......................................................... 80 Timer1 T1CON ............................................................... 71 T1GCON............................................................. 72 Timer2 T2CON ............................................................... 76 Timing Diagrams A/D Conversion......................................................... 210 A/D Conversion (Sleep Mode) .................................. 211 Brown-out Reset (BOR)............................................ 203 Brown-out Reset Situations ...................................... 165 Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) ................................ 206 CLKOUT and I/O ...................................................... 202 Clock Timing ............................................................. 200 Comparator Output ................................................... 133 INT Pin Interrupt ....................................................... 173 Time-out Sequence Case 1 .............................................................. 166 Case 2 .............................................................. 167 Case 3 .............................................................. 167 Timer0 and Timer1 External Clock ........................... 205 Timer1 Incrementing Edge ......................................... 67 Wake-up from Interrupt............................................. 178 Timing Parameter Symbology .......................................... 199 TRISA Register............................................................. 46, 52 V VREF. SEE ADC Reference Voltage W Wake-up Using Interrupts ................................................. 177 Watchdog Timer (WDT).................................................... 174 Associated registers ................................................. 176 Specifications ........................................................... 204 WPUA Register............................................................. 48, 55 Writing the Flash Program Memory .................................... 32 WWW Address ................................................................. 233 WWW, On-Line Support ................................................... 2, 5 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 THE MICROCHIP WEB SITE CUSTOMER SUPPORT Microchip provides online support via our WWW site at www.microchip.com. This web site is used as a means to make files and information easily available to customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet browser, the web site contains the following information: Users of Microchip products can receive assistance through several channels: • Product Support – Data sheets and errata, application notes and sample programs, design resources, user’s guides and hardware support documents, latest software releases and archived software • General Technical Support – Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), technical support requests, online discussion groups, Microchip consultant program member listing • Business of Microchip – Product selector and ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases, listing of seminars and events, listings of Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory representatives • • • • • Distributor or Representative Local Sales Office Field Application Engineer (FAE) Technical Support Development Systems Information Line Customers should contact their distributor, representative or field application engineer (FAE) for support. Local sales offices are also available to help customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is included in the back of this document. Technical support is available through the web site at: http://microchip.com/support CUSTOMER CHANGE NOTIFICATION SERVICE Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers will receive e-mail notification whenever there are changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a specified product family or development tool of interest. To register, access the Microchip web site at www.microchip.com. Under “Support”, click on “Customer Change Notification” and follow the registration instructions. 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 233 PIC16F753/HV753 READER RESPONSE It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip product. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter, and ways in which our documentation can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (480) 792-4150. Please list the following information, and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this document. TO: Technical Publications Manager RE: Reader Response Total Pages Sent ________ From: Name Company Address City / State / ZIP / Country Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________ FAX: (______) _________ - _________ Application (optional): Would you like a reply? Y N Device: PIC16F753/HV753 Literature Number: DS40001709A Questions: 1. What are the best features of this document? 2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs? 3. Do you find the organization of this document easy to follow? If not, why? 4. What additions to the document do you think would enhance the structure and subject? 5. What deletions from the document could be made without affecting the overall usefulness? 6. Is there any incorrect or misleading information (what and where)? 7. How would you improve this document? DS40001709A-page 234 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. PIC16F753/HV753 PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales office. [X](1) PART NO. Device - X Tape and Reel Temperature Option Range /XX XXX Package Pattern Examples: a) b) Device: PIC16F753 PIC16HV753 Tape and Reel Option: Blank T = Standard packaging (tube or tray) = Tape and Reel(1) Temperature Range: I E = -40C to +85C = -40C to +125C Package: P SL ST = = = ML = c) d) Pattern: (Industrial) (Extended) 14-lead Plastic Dual In-line (PDIP) 14-lead Plastic Small Outline (3.90 mm) (SOIC) 14-lead Plastic Thin Shrink Small Outline (4.4 mm) (TSSOP) 16-lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (4x4x0.9 mm) (QFN) PIC16F753-I/ML301 Tape and Reel, Industrial temperature, QFN 4x43 package, QTP pattern #301 PIC16F753-E/P Extended temperature PDIP package PIC16F753-E/SL Extended temperature, SOIC package PIC16HV753-E/ST Extended temperature, TSSOP 4.4 mm package Note 1: Tape and Reel identifier only appears in the catalog part number description. This identifier is used for ordering purposes and is not printed on the device package. Check with your Microchip Sales Office for package availability with the Tape and Reel option. QTP, SQTP, Code or Special Requirements (blank otherwise) 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 235 PIC16F753/HV753 NOTES: DS40001709A-page 236 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices: • Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet. • Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the intended manner and under normal conditions. • There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property. • Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code. • Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.” Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act. Information contained in this publication regarding device applications and the like is provided only for your convenience and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to ensure that your application meets with your specifications. MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE, RELATED TO THE INFORMATION, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION, QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR PURPOSE. Microchip disclaims all liability arising from this information and its use. Use of Microchip devices in life support and/or safety applications is entirely at the buyer’s risk, and the buyer agrees to defend, indemnify and hold harmless Microchip from any and all damages, claims, suits, or expenses resulting from such use. No licenses are conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any Microchip intellectual property rights. Trademarks The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, dsPIC, FlashFlex, KEELOQ, KEELOQ logo, MPLAB, PIC, PICmicro, PICSTART, PIC32 logo, rfPIC, SST, SST Logo, SuperFlash and UNI/O are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries. FilterLab, Hampshire, HI-TECH C, Linear Active Thermistor, MTP, SEEVAL and The Embedded Control Solutions Company are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. Silicon Storage Technology is a registered trademark of Microchip Technology Inc. in other countries. Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Application Maestro, BodyCom, chipKIT, chipKIT logo, CodeGuard, dsPICDEM, dsPICDEM.net, dsPICworks, dsSPEAK, ECAN, ECONOMONITOR, FanSense, HI-TIDE, In-Circuit Serial Programming, ICSP, Mindi, MiWi, MPASM, MPF, MPLAB Certified logo, MPLIB, MPLINK, mTouch, Omniscient Code Generation, PICC, PICC-18, PICDEM, PICDEM.net, PICkit, PICtail, REAL ICE, rfLAB, Select Mode, SQI, Serial Quad I/O, Total Endurance, TSHARC, UniWinDriver, WiperLock, ZENA and Z-Scale are trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries. SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. GestIC and ULPP are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Germany II GmbH & Co. KG, a subsidiary of Microchip Technology Inc., in other countries. All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their respective companies. © 2013, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in the U.S.A., All Rights Reserved. Printed on recycled paper. ISBN: 9781620771976 QUALITY MANAGEMENT SYSTEM CERTIFIED BY DNV == ISO/TS 16949 == 2013 Microchip Technology Inc. Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2009 certification for its worldwide headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in Chandler and Tempe, Arizona; Gresham, Oregon and design centers in California and India. The Company’s quality system processes and procedures are for its PIC® MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs, KEELOQ® code hopping devices, Serial EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and analog products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design and manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified. Preliminary DS40001709A-page 237 Worldwide Sales and Service AMERICAS ASIA/PACIFIC ASIA/PACIFIC EUROPE Corporate Office 2355 West Chandler Blvd. Chandler, AZ 85224-6199 Tel: 480-792-7200 Fax: 480-792-7277 Technical Support: http://www.microchip.com/ support Web Address: www.microchip.com Asia Pacific Office Suites 3707-14, 37th Floor Tower 6, The Gateway Harbour City, Kowloon Hong Kong Tel: 852-2401-1200 Fax: 852-2401-3431 India - Bangalore Tel: 91-80-3090-4444 Fax: 91-80-3090-4123 India - New Delhi Tel: 91-11-4160-8631 Fax: 91-11-4160-8632 Austria - Wels Tel: 43-7242-2244-39 Fax: 43-7242-2244-393 Denmark - Copenhagen Tel: 45-4450-2828 Fax: 45-4485-2829 India - Pune Tel: 91-20-2566-1512 Fax: 91-20-2566-1513 France - Paris Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20 Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79 Japan - Osaka Tel: 81-6-6152-7160 Fax: 81-6-6152-9310 Germany - Munich Tel: 49-89-627-144-0 Fax: 49-89-627-144-44 Atlanta Duluth, GA Tel: 678-957-9614 Fax: 678-957-1455 Boston Westborough, MA Tel: 774-760-0087 Fax: 774-760-0088 Chicago Itasca, IL Tel: 630-285-0071 Fax: 630-285-0075 Cleveland Independence, OH Tel: 216-447-0464 Fax: 216-447-0643 Dallas Addison, TX Tel: 972-818-7423 Fax: 972-818-2924 Detroit Farmington Hills, MI Tel: 248-538-2250 Fax: 248-538-2260 Indianapolis Noblesville, IN Tel: 317-773-8323 Fax: 317-773-5453 Los Angeles Mission Viejo, CA Tel: 949-462-9523 Fax: 949-462-9608 Santa Clara Santa Clara, CA Tel: 408-961-6444 Fax: 408-961-6445 Toronto Mississauga, Ontario, Canada Tel: 905-673-0699 Fax: 905-673-6509 Australia - Sydney Tel: 61-2-9868-6733 Fax: 61-2-9868-6755 China - Beijing Tel: 86-10-8569-7000 Fax: 86-10-8528-2104 Japan - Tokyo Tel: 81-3-6880- 3770 Fax: 81-3-6880-3771 China - Chengdu Tel: 86-28-8665-5511 Fax: 86-28-8665-7889 Korea - Daegu Tel: 82-53-744-4301 Fax: 82-53-744-4302 China - Chongqing Tel: 86-23-8980-9588 Fax: 86-23-8980-9500 China - Hangzhou Tel: 86-571-2819-3187 Fax: 86-571-2819-3189 Korea - Seoul Tel: 82-2-554-7200 Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or 82-2-558-5934 China - Hong Kong SAR Tel: 852-2943-5100 Fax: 852-2401-3431 Malaysia - Kuala Lumpur Tel: 60-3-6201-9857 Fax: 60-3-6201-9859 China - Nanjing Tel: 86-25-8473-2460 Fax: 86-25-8473-2470 Malaysia - Penang Tel: 60-4-227-8870 Fax: 60-4-227-4068 China - Qingdao Tel: 86-532-8502-7355 Fax: 86-532-8502-7205 Philippines - Manila Tel: 63-2-634-9065 Fax: 63-2-634-9069 China - Shanghai Tel: 86-21-5407-5533 Fax: 86-21-5407-5066 Singapore Tel: 65-6334-8870 Fax: 65-6334-8850 China - Shenyang Tel: 86-24-2334-2829 Fax: 86-24-2334-2393 Taiwan - Hsin Chu Tel: 886-3-5778-366 Fax: 886-3-5770-955 China - Shenzhen Tel: 86-755-8864-2200 Fax: 86-755-8203-1760 Taiwan - Kaohsiung Tel: 886-7-213-7828 Fax: 886-7-330-9305 China - Wuhan Tel: 86-27-5980-5300 Fax: 86-27-5980-5118 Taiwan - Taipei Tel: 886-2-2508-8600 Fax: 886-2-2508-0102 China - Xian Tel: 86-29-8833-7252 Fax: 86-29-8833-7256 Thailand - Bangkok Tel: 66-2-694-1351 Fax: 66-2-694-1350 Netherlands - Drunen Tel: 31-416-690399 Fax: 31-416-690340 Spain - Madrid Tel: 34-91-708-08-90 Fax: 34-91-708-08-91 UK - Wokingham Tel: 44-118-921-5869 Fax: 44-118-921-5820 China - Xiamen Tel: 86-592-2388138 Fax: 86-592-2388130 China - Zhuhai Tel: 86-756-3210040 Fax: 86-756-3210049 DS40001709A-page 238 Italy - Milan Tel: 39-0331-742611 Fax: 39-0331-466781 11/29/12 Preliminary 2013 Microchip Technology Inc.